]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - bfd/elf32-ppc.c
Complain about mbind, ifunc, and unique in final_write
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf32-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1994-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the
19 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI. The
24 information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI. It includes
25 suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26 information may also not match. */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 #include "dwarf2.h"
38 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39
40 typedef enum split16_format_type
41 {
42 split16a_type = 0,
43 split16d_type
44 }
45 split16_format_type;
46
47 /* RELA relocations are used here. */
48
49 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
50 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
52 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53
54 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
55 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
56 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
57 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
58 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
59 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
60
61 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
62 section. */
63 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
64
65 /* For old-style PLT. */
66 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
67 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
68
69 /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
70 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
71 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
72 ((4*4 \
73 + (h != NULL \
74 && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
75 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
76 + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
77 & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
78
79 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
80
81 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
82 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
83 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
84 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
85 {
86 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
87 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
88 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
89 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
90 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
91 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
92 0x60000000, /* nop */
93 0x60000000, /* nop */
94 };
95 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
96 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
97 {
98 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
99 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
100 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
101 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
102 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
103 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
104 0x60000000, /* nop */
105 0x60000000, /* nop */
106 };
107
108 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
109 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
110 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
111 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
112 {
113 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
114 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
115 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
116 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
117 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
118 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
119 0x60000000, /* nop */
120 0x60000000, /* nop */
121 };
122 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
123 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
124 {
125 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
126 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
127 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
128 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
129 0x60000000, /* nop */
130 0x60000000, /* nop */
131 0x60000000, /* nop */
132 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 };
134
135 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
136 .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
137
138 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
139 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
140 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
141 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
142 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
143 a shared library. */
144 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
145
146 /* Some instructions. */
147 #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
148 #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
149 #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
150 #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
151 #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
152 #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
153 #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
154 #define B 0x48000000
155 #define BA 0x48000002
156 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
157 #define BCTR 0x4e800420
158 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
159 #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
160 #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
161 #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
162 #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
163 #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
164 #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
165 #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
166 #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
167 #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
168 #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
169 #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
170 #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
171 #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
172 #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
173 #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
174 #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
175 #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
176 #define NOP 0x60000000
177 #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
178
179 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
180 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
181 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
182
183 /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
184 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
185 ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
186 + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
187 + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
188 \f
189 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
190 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
191 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
192 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
193 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
194 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
195 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
196 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
197 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
198 complain, special_func) \
199 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
200 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
201 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
202
203 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
204
205 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
206 /* This reloc does nothing. */
207 HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
208 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
209
210 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
211 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
212 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
213
214 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
215 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
216 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
217 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
218
219 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
220 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
221 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
222
223 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
224 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
225 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
226
227 /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
228 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
229 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
230
231 /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
232 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
233 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
234 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
235
236 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
237 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
238 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
239 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
240
241 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
242 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
243 bits must be zero. */
244 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
245 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
246
247 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
248 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
249 two bits must be zero. */
250 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
251 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
252
253 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
254 HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
255 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
256
257 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
258 HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
259 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
260
261 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
262 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
263 zero. */
264 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
265 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
266
267 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
268 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
269 be zero. */
270 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
271 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
272
273 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
274 symbol. */
275 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
276 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
277
278 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
279 the symbol. */
280 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
281 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
282
283 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
284 the symbol. */
285 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
286 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
287
288 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
289 the symbol. */
290 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
291 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
292
293 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
294 entry for the symbol. */
295 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
296 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
297
298 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
299 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
300 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
301 shared library into the object, because the object being
302 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
303 HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
304 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
305
306 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
307 entries. */
308 HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
309 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
310
311 /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
312 HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
313 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
314
315 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
316 longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
317 addend. */
318 HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
319 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
320
321 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
322 object rather than the final value. Normally used for
323 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
324 HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
325 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
326
327 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
328 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
329 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
330
331 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
332 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
333 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
334
335 /* 32-bit PC relative */
336 HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
337 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
338
339 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
340 FIXME: not supported. */
341 HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
342 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
343
344 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
345 FIXME: not supported. */
346 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
347 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
348
349 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
350 the symbol. */
351 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
352 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
353
354 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
355 the symbol. */
356 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
357 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
358
359 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
360 the symbol. */
361 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
362 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
363
364 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
365 small data items. */
366 HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
367 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
368
369 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
370 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
371 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
372
373 /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
374 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
375 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
376
377 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
378 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
379 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
380
381 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
382 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
383 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
384
385 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
386 HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
387 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
388
389 HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
390 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391
392 HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
393 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394
395 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
396 HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
397 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
398
399 HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
400 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401
402 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
403 definition of its TLS sym. */
404 HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
405 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
406
407 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
408 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
409 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
410 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
411 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
412
413 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
414 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
415 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
416
417 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
418 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
419 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
420
421 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
422 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
423 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
424
425 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
426 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
427 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
428
429 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
430 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
431 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
432 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
433
434 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
435 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
436 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
437
438 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
439 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
440 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
441
442 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
443 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
444 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
445
446 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
447 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
448 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
449
450 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
451 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
452 to the first entry. */
453 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
454 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
455
456 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
457 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
458 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
459
460 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
461 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
462 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
463
464 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
465 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
466 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
467
468 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
469 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
470 first entry. */
471 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
472 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
473
474 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
475 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
476 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
477
478 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
479 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
480 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
481
482 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
483 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
484 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
485
486 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
487 the offset to the entry. */
488 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
489 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
490
491 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
492 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
493 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
494
495 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
496 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
497 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
498
499 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
500 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
501 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
502
503 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
504 offset to the entry. */
505 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
506 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
507
508 /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
509 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
510 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
511
512 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
513 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
514 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
515
516 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
517 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
518 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
519
520 /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
521 in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
522
523 /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
524 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
525 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
526
527 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
528 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
529 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
530
531 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
532 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
533 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
534
535 /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
536 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
537 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
538
539 /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
540 plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
541 is negative. */
542 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
543 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
544
545 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
546 address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
547 _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
548 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
549 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
550
551 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
552 address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
553 _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
554 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
555 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
556
557 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
558 small data items. */
559 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
560 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
561
562 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
563 signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
564 field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
565 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
566 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
567
568 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
569 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
570 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
571 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
572 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
573 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
574
575 /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
576 in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
577 register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
578 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
579 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
580
581 /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
582 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
583 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
584
585 /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
586 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
587 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
588
589 /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
590 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
591 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
592
593 /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
594 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
595 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
596
597 /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
598 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
599 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
600
601 /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
602 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
603 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
604
605 /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
606 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
607 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
608
609 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
610 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
611 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
612
613 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
614 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
615 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
616
617 /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
618 instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
619 the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
620 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
621 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
622
623 /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
624 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
625 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
626
627 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
628 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
629 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
630
631 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
632 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
633 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
634
635 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
636 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
637 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
638
639 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
640 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
641 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
642
643 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
644 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
645 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
646
647 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
648 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
649 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
650
651 /* e_li split20 format. */
652 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
653 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
654
655 HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
656 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
659 HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
660 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
661
662 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
663 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
664 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
665
666 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
667 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
668 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
669
670 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
671 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
672 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
673 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
674
675 /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
676 HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
677 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
678
679 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
680 HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
681 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
682
683 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
684 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
685 NULL),
686
687 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
688 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
689 NULL),
690
691 /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
692 HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
693 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
694 };
695 \f
696 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
697
698 static void
699 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
700 {
701 unsigned int i, type;
702
703 for (i = 0;
704 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
705 i++)
706 {
707 type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
708 if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
709 / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
710 abort ();
711 ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
712 }
713 }
714
715 static reloc_howto_type *
716 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
717 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
718 {
719 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
720
721 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
722 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
723 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
724
725 switch (code)
726 {
727 default:
728 return NULL;
729
730 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
731 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
732 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
733 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
734 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
735 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
736 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
737 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
738 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
739 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
740 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
741 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
742 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
743 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
744 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
745 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
746 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
747 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
748 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
749 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
750 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
751 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
752 case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
753 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
754 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
755 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
756 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
757 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
758 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
759 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
760 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
761 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
762 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
763 case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
764 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
765 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
766 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
767 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
768 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
769 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
770 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
771 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
772 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
773 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
774 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
775 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
776 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
777 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
778 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
779 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
780 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
781 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
782 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
783 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
784 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
785 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
786 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
787 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
788 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
789 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
790 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
791 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
792 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
793 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
794 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
795 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
796 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
797 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
798 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
799 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
800 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
801 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
802 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
803 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
804 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
805 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
806 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
807 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
808 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
809 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
810 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
811 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
812 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
813 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
814 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
815 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
816 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
817 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
818 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
819 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
820 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
821 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
822 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
823 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
824 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
825 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
826 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
827 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
828 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
829 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
830 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
831 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
832 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
833 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
834 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
835 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
836 break;
837 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
838 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
839 break;
840 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
841 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
842 break;
843 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
844 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
845 break;
846 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
847 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
848 break;
849 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
850 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
851 break;
852 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
853 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
854 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
855 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
856 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
857 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
858 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
859 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
860 }
861
862 return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
863 };
864
865 static reloc_howto_type *
866 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
867 const char *r_name)
868 {
869 unsigned int i;
870
871 for (i = 0;
872 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
873 i++)
874 if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
875 && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
876 return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
877
878 return NULL;
879 }
880
881 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
882
883 static bfd_boolean
884 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
885 arelent *cache_ptr,
886 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
887 {
888 unsigned int r_type;
889
890 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
891 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
892 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
893
894 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
895 if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
896 {
897 /* xgettext:c-format */
898 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
899 abfd, r_type);
900 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
901 return FALSE;
902 }
903
904 cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
905
906 /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
907 ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
908 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
909 {
910 /* xgettext:c-format */
911 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
912 abfd, r_type);
913 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
914
915 return FALSE;
916 }
917
918 return TRUE;
919 }
920
921 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
922
923 static bfd_reloc_status_type
924 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
925 arelent *reloc_entry,
926 asymbol *symbol,
927 void *data,
928 asection *input_section,
929 bfd *output_bfd,
930 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
931 {
932 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
933 long insn;
934 bfd_size_type octets;
935 bfd_vma value;
936
937 if (output_bfd != NULL)
938 {
939 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
940 return bfd_reloc_ok;
941 }
942
943 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
944 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
945 if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
946 return bfd_reloc_continue;
947
948 value = 0;
949 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
950 value = symbol->value;
951 value += (reloc_entry->addend
952 + symbol->section->output_offset
953 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
954 value -= (reloc_entry->address
955 + input_section->output_offset
956 + input_section->output_section->vma);
957 value >>= 16;
958
959 octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
960 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
961 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
962 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
963 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
964 return bfd_reloc_ok;
965 }
966
967 static bfd_reloc_status_type
968 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
969 arelent *reloc_entry,
970 asymbol *symbol,
971 void *data,
972 asection *input_section,
973 bfd *output_bfd,
974 char **error_message)
975 {
976 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
977 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
978 link time. */
979 if (output_bfd != NULL)
980 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
981 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
982
983 if (error_message != NULL)
984 {
985 static char buf[60];
986 sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
987 reloc_entry->howto->name);
988 *error_message = buf;
989 }
990 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
991 }
992 \f
993 /* Sections created by the linker. */
994
995 typedef struct elf_linker_section
996 {
997 /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
998 asection *section;
999 /* Section name. */
1000 const char *name;
1001 /* Associated bss section name. */
1002 const char *bss_name;
1003 /* Associated symbol name. */
1004 const char *sym_name;
1005 /* Associated symbol. */
1006 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1007 } elf_linker_section_t;
1008
1009 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1010 symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1011 based on different addend's. */
1012
1013 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1014 {
1015 /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1016 struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1017 /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1018 bfd_vma offset;
1019 /* addend used */
1020 bfd_vma addend;
1021 /* which linker section this is */
1022 elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1023 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1024
1025 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1026 {
1027 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1028
1029 /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1030 sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1031 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1032
1033 /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1034 unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1035 unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1036 };
1037
1038 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1039 ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1040
1041 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1042 (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1043
1044 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1045 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1046 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1047
1048 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1049
1050 static bfd_boolean
1051 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1052 {
1053 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1054 PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1055 }
1056
1057 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1058
1059 bfd_boolean
1060 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1061 {
1062 unsigned long mach = 0;
1063 asection *s;
1064 unsigned char *contents;
1065
1066 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1067 && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1068 {
1069
1070 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1071 if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1072 break;
1073 if (s != NULL)
1074 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1075 }
1076
1077 if (mach == 0)
1078 {
1079 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1080 if (s != NULL
1081 && s->size >= 24
1082 && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1083 {
1084 unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1085 unsigned int i;
1086
1087 for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1088 {
1089 unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1090 switch (val >> 16)
1091 {
1092 case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1093 case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1094 if (mach == 0)
1095 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1096 break;
1097
1098 case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1099 case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1100 if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1101 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1102 break;
1103
1104 case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1105 case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1106 case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1107 if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1108 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1109 break;
1110
1111 case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1112 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1113 break;
1114
1115 default:
1116 mach = -1ul;
1117 }
1118 }
1119 free (contents);
1120 }
1121 }
1122
1123 if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1124 {
1125 const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1126
1127 for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1128 if (arch->mach == mach)
1129 {
1130 abfd->arch_info = arch;
1131 break;
1132 }
1133 }
1134 return TRUE;
1135 }
1136
1137 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1138 default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1139
1140 static bfd_boolean
1141 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1142 {
1143 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1144 return TRUE;
1145
1146 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1147 {
1148 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1149
1150 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1151 {
1152 /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1153 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1154 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1155 }
1156 }
1157 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1158 }
1159
1160 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1161
1162 static bfd_boolean
1163 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1164 {
1165 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1166 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1167
1168 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1169 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1170 return TRUE;
1171 }
1172
1173 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1174
1175 static bfd_boolean
1176 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1177 {
1178 int offset;
1179 unsigned int size;
1180
1181 switch (note->descsz)
1182 {
1183 default:
1184 return FALSE;
1185
1186 case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1187 /* pr_cursig */
1188 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1189
1190 /* pr_pid */
1191 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1192
1193 /* pr_reg */
1194 offset = 72;
1195 size = 192;
1196
1197 break;
1198 }
1199
1200 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1201 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1202 size, note->descpos + offset);
1203 }
1204
1205 static bfd_boolean
1206 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1207 {
1208 switch (note->descsz)
1209 {
1210 default:
1211 return FALSE;
1212
1213 case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1214 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1215 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1216 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1217 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1218 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1219 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1220 }
1221
1222 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1223 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1224 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1225
1226 {
1227 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1228 int n = strlen (command);
1229
1230 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1231 command[n - 1] = '\0';
1232 }
1233
1234 return TRUE;
1235 }
1236
1237 static char *
1238 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1239 {
1240 switch (note_type)
1241 {
1242 default:
1243 return NULL;
1244
1245 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1246 {
1247 char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1248 va_list ap;
1249
1250 va_start (ap, note_type);
1251 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1252 strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1253 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1254 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1255 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1256 -Wstringop-truncation:
1257 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1258 */
1259 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1260 #endif
1261 strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1262 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1263 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1264 #endif
1265 va_end (ap);
1266 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1267 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1268 }
1269
1270 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1271 {
1272 char data[268];
1273 va_list ap;
1274 long pid;
1275 int cursig;
1276 const void *greg;
1277
1278 va_start (ap, note_type);
1279 memset (data, 0, 72);
1280 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1281 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1282 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1283 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1284 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1285 memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1286 memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1287 va_end (ap);
1288 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1289 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1290 }
1291 }
1292 }
1293
1294 static flagword
1295 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1296 {
1297
1298 if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1299 return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1300
1301 return 0;
1302 }
1303
1304 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1305 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1306
1307 static bfd_vma
1308 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1309 const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1310 const arelent *rel)
1311 {
1312 return rel->address;
1313 }
1314
1315 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1316 is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1317 type. */
1318
1319 static bfd_boolean
1320 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1321 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1322 const char *name,
1323 int shindex)
1324 {
1325 asection *newsect;
1326 flagword flags;
1327
1328 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1329 return FALSE;
1330
1331 newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1332 flags = bfd_get_section_flags (abfd, newsect);
1333 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1334 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1335
1336 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1337 flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1338
1339 bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags);
1340 return TRUE;
1341 }
1342
1343 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1344
1345 static bfd_boolean
1346 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1347 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1348 asection *asect)
1349 {
1350 if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1351 shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1352
1353 return TRUE;
1354 }
1355
1356 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1357 need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1358
1359 static int
1360 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1361 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1362 {
1363 asection *s;
1364 int ret = 0;
1365
1366 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1367 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1368 ++ret;
1369
1370 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1371 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1372 ++ret;
1373
1374 return ret;
1375 }
1376
1377 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1378
1379 bfd_boolean
1380 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1381 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1382 {
1383 struct elf_segment_map *m;
1384
1385 /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1386 LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1387 there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1388 If we find that case, we split the segment.
1389 We maintain the original output section order. */
1390
1391 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1392 {
1393 struct elf_segment_map *n;
1394 bfd_size_type amt;
1395 unsigned int j, k;
1396 unsigned int p_flags;
1397
1398 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1399 continue;
1400
1401 for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1402 {
1403 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1404 p_flags |= PF_W;
1405 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1406 {
1407 p_flags |= PF_X;
1408 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1409 p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1410 break;
1411 }
1412 }
1413 if (j != m->count)
1414 while (++j != m->count)
1415 {
1416 unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1417
1418 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1419 p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1420 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1421 {
1422 p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1423 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1424 p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1425 if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1426 break;
1427 }
1428 p_flags |= p_flags1;
1429 }
1430 /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1431 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1432 two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1433 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1434 if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1435 {
1436 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1437 m->p_flags = p_flags;
1438 }
1439 if (j == m->count)
1440 continue;
1441
1442 /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1443 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1444 The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1445
1446 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1447 amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1448 n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1449 if (n == NULL)
1450 return FALSE;
1451
1452 n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1453 n->count = m->count - j;
1454 for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1455 n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1456 m->count = j;
1457 m->p_size_valid = 0;
1458 n->next = m->next;
1459 m->next = n;
1460 }
1461
1462 return TRUE;
1463 }
1464
1465 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1466 .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1467 that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1468 2 sections. */
1469
1470 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1471 {
1472 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1473 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1474 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1475 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1476 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1477 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1478 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1479 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1480 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1481 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1482 };
1483
1484 /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1485 static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1486 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1487
1488 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1489 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1490 {
1491 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1492
1493 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1494 if (sec->name == NULL)
1495 return NULL;
1496
1497 ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1498 sec->use_rela_p);
1499 if (ssect != NULL)
1500 {
1501 if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1502 ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1503 return ssect;
1504 }
1505
1506 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1507 }
1508 \f
1509 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1510 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1511 {
1512 struct apuinfo_list *next;
1513 unsigned long value;
1514 }
1515 apuinfo_list;
1516
1517 static apuinfo_list *head;
1518 static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1519
1520 static void
1521 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1522 {
1523 head = NULL;
1524 apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1525 }
1526
1527 static void
1528 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1529 {
1530 apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1531
1532 while (entry != NULL)
1533 {
1534 if (entry->value == value)
1535 return;
1536 entry = entry->next;
1537 }
1538
1539 entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1540 if (entry == NULL)
1541 return;
1542
1543 entry->value = value;
1544 entry->next = head;
1545 head = entry;
1546 }
1547
1548 static unsigned
1549 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1550 {
1551 apuinfo_list *entry;
1552 unsigned long count;
1553
1554 for (entry = head, count = 0;
1555 entry;
1556 entry = entry->next)
1557 ++ count;
1558
1559 return count;
1560 }
1561
1562 static inline unsigned long
1563 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1564 {
1565 apuinfo_list * entry;
1566
1567 for (entry = head;
1568 entry && number --;
1569 entry = entry->next)
1570 ;
1571
1572 return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1573 }
1574
1575 static void
1576 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1577 {
1578 apuinfo_list *entry;
1579
1580 for (entry = head; entry;)
1581 {
1582 apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1583 free (entry);
1584 entry = next;
1585 }
1586
1587 head = NULL;
1588 }
1589
1590 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1591 the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1592
1593 static void
1594 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1595 {
1596 bfd *ibfd;
1597 asection *asec;
1598 char *buffer = NULL;
1599 bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1600 unsigned i;
1601 unsigned long length;
1602 const char *error_message = NULL;
1603
1604 if (link_info == NULL)
1605 return;
1606
1607 apuinfo_list_init ();
1608
1609 /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1610 for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1611 {
1612 unsigned long datum;
1613
1614 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1615 if (asec == NULL)
1616 continue;
1617
1618 /* xgettext:c-format */
1619 error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1620 length = asec->size;
1621 if (length < 20)
1622 goto fail;
1623
1624 apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1625 if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1626 {
1627 if (buffer)
1628 free (buffer);
1629 largest_input_size = asec->size;
1630 buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1631 if (!buffer)
1632 return;
1633 }
1634
1635 if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1636 || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1637 {
1638 /* xgettext:c-format */
1639 error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1640 goto fail;
1641 }
1642
1643 /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1644 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1645 host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1646 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1647 if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1648 goto fail;
1649
1650 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1651 if (datum != 0x2)
1652 goto fail;
1653
1654 if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1655 goto fail;
1656
1657 /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1658 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1659 if (datum + 20 != length)
1660 goto fail;
1661
1662 /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1663 for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1664 apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1665 }
1666
1667 error_message = NULL;
1668
1669 if (apuinfo_set)
1670 {
1671 /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1672 unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1673
1674 /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1675 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1676
1677 if (asec && ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1678 {
1679 ibfd = abfd;
1680 /* xgettext:c-format */
1681 error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1682 }
1683 }
1684
1685 fail:
1686 if (buffer)
1687 free (buffer);
1688
1689 if (error_message)
1690 _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1691 }
1692
1693 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1694 contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1695
1696 static bfd_boolean
1697 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1698 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1699 asection *asec,
1700 bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1701 {
1702 return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1703 }
1704
1705 /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1706
1707 static void
1708 ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1709 {
1710 bfd_byte *buffer;
1711 asection *asec;
1712 unsigned i;
1713 unsigned num_entries;
1714 bfd_size_type length;
1715
1716 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1717 if (asec == NULL)
1718 return;
1719
1720 if (!apuinfo_set)
1721 return;
1722
1723 length = asec->size;
1724 if (length < 20)
1725 return;
1726
1727 buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1728 if (buffer == NULL)
1729 {
1730 _bfd_error_handler
1731 (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1732 return;
1733 }
1734
1735 /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1736 num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1737 bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1738 bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1739 bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1740 strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1741
1742 length = 20;
1743 for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1744 {
1745 bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1746 length += 4;
1747 }
1748
1749 if (length != asec->size)
1750 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1751
1752 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1753 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1754
1755 free (buffer);
1756
1757 apuinfo_list_finish ();
1758 }
1759
1760 static bfd_boolean
1761 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1762 {
1763 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1764 return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1765 }
1766 \f
1767 static bfd_boolean
1768 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1769 {
1770 bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1771
1772 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1773 return FALSE;
1774
1775 return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1776 && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1777 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1778 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1779 }
1780
1781 static bfd_boolean
1782 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1783 {
1784 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1785 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1786 && section->vma <= vma
1787 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1788 }
1789
1790 static long
1791 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1792 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1793 asymbol **ret)
1794 {
1795 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1796 asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1797 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1798 bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1799 bfd_vma stub_off;
1800 asymbol *s;
1801 arelent *p;
1802 long count, i, stub_delta;
1803 size_t size;
1804 char *names;
1805 bfd_byte buf[4];
1806
1807 *ret = NULL;
1808
1809 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1810 return 0;
1811
1812 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1813 return 0;
1814
1815 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1816 if (relplt == NULL)
1817 return 0;
1818
1819 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1820 if (plt == NULL)
1821 return 0;
1822
1823 /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1824 if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1825 return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1826 dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1827
1828 /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1829 of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1830 dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1831 if (dynamic != NULL)
1832 {
1833 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1834 size_t extdynsize;
1835 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1836
1837 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1838 return -1;
1839
1840 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1841 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1842
1843 extdyn = dynbuf;
1844 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1845 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1846 {
1847 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1848 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1849
1850 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1851 break;
1852
1853 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1854 {
1855 unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1856 asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1857 if (got != NULL
1858 && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1859 g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1860 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1861 break;
1862 }
1863 }
1864 free (dynbuf);
1865 }
1866
1867 /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1868 if (glink_vma == 0)
1869 {
1870 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1871 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1872 }
1873
1874 if (glink_vma == 0)
1875 return 0;
1876
1877 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1878 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1879 glink stubs now reside. */
1880 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1881 if (glink == NULL)
1882 return 0;
1883
1884 /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1885 from the first glink stub. */
1886 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1887 glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1888 {
1889 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1890
1891 /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1892 insn ^= B;
1893 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1894 resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1895
1896 /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1897 else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1898 for (i = 4;
1899 bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1900 glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1901 i += 4)
1902 if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1903 {
1904 resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1905 break;
1906 }
1907 }
1908
1909 count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1910 /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1911 multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1912 there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1913 of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1914 The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1915 GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1916 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1917 for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1918 if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1919 break;
1920 if (stub_delta > 32)
1921 return 0;
1922
1923 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1924 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1925 return -1;
1926
1927 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1928 p = relplt->relocation;
1929 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1930 {
1931 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1932 if (p->addend != 0)
1933 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1934 }
1935
1936 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1937
1938 if (resolv_vma)
1939 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1940
1941 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1942 if (s == NULL)
1943 return -1;
1944
1945 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1946 names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1947 p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1948 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1949 {
1950 size_t len;
1951
1952 stub_off -= stub_delta;
1953 if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1954 stub_off -= 32;
1955 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1956 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1957 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1958 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1959 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1960 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1961 s->section = glink;
1962 s->value = stub_off;
1963 s->name = names;
1964 s->udata.p = NULL;
1965 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1966 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1967 names += len;
1968 if (p->addend != 0)
1969 {
1970 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1971 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1972 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1973 names += strlen (names);
1974 }
1975 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1976 names += sizeof ("@plt");
1977 ++s;
1978 --p;
1979 }
1980
1981 /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1982 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1983 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1984 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1985 s->section = glink;
1986 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1987 s->name = names;
1988 memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
1989 names += sizeof ("__glink");
1990 s++;
1991 count++;
1992
1993 if (resolv_vma)
1994 {
1995 /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
1996 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1997 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1998 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1999 s->section = glink;
2000 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2001 s->name = names;
2002 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2003 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2004 s++;
2005 count++;
2006 }
2007
2008 return count;
2009 }
2010 \f
2011 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2012 functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2013 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2014 ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2015 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2016 called. */
2017
2018 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2019 than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2020 struct plt_entry
2021 {
2022 struct plt_entry *next;
2023
2024 /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2025 This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2026 GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2027 gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2028 sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2029 bfd_vma addend;
2030
2031 /* The .got2 section. */
2032 asection *sec;
2033
2034 /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2035 union
2036 {
2037 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2038 bfd_vma offset;
2039 } plt;
2040
2041 /* .glink stub offset. */
2042 bfd_vma glink_offset;
2043 };
2044
2045 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2046 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2047 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2048
2049 static int
2050 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2051 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2052 {
2053 switch (r_type)
2054 {
2055 default:
2056 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2057 address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2058 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2059 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2060 return 1;
2061
2062 case R_PPC_REL24:
2063 case R_PPC_REL14:
2064 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2065 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2066 case R_PPC_REL32:
2067 return 0;
2068
2069 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2070 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2071 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2072 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2073 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2074 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2075 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2076 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2077 }
2078 }
2079
2080 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2081 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2082 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2083 shared lib. */
2084 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2085
2086 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2087 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2088 {
2089 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2090
2091 /* The input section of the reloc. */
2092 asection *sec;
2093
2094 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2095 unsigned int count : 31;
2096
2097 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2098 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2099 };
2100
2101 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2102
2103 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2104 {
2105 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2106
2107 /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2108 specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2109 from the beginning of the section. */
2110 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2111
2112 /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
2113 struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
2114
2115 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2116 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2117 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2118 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2119 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2120 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2121 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2122 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2123 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2124 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2125 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2126 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2127 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2128 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2129 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2130 unsigned char tls_mask;
2131
2132 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2133 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2134 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2135 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2136 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2137
2138 /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2139 symbol. */
2140 unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2141
2142 /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2143 unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2144 unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2145 };
2146
2147 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2148
2149 /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2150
2151 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2152 {
2153 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2154
2155 /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2156 struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2157
2158 /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2159 asection *glink;
2160 asection *dynsbss;
2161 asection *relsbss;
2162 elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2163 asection *sbss;
2164 asection *glink_eh_frame;
2165 asection *pltlocal;
2166 asection *relpltlocal;
2167
2168 /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2169 asection *srelplt2;
2170
2171 /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2172 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2173
2174 /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2175 bfd *old_bfd;
2176
2177 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2178 union {
2179 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2180 bfd_vma offset;
2181 } tlsld_got;
2182
2183 /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2184 bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2185
2186 /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2187 unsigned int got_header_size;
2188 /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2189 unsigned int got_gap;
2190
2191 /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2192 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2193
2194 /* True if the target system is VxWorks. */
2195 unsigned int is_vxworks:1;
2196
2197 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2198 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2199 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2200 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2201
2202 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2203 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2204
2205 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2206 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2207
2208 /* The size of PLT entries. */
2209 int plt_entry_size;
2210 /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2211 int plt_slot_size;
2212 /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2213 int plt_initial_entry_size;
2214
2215 /* Small local sym cache. */
2216 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
2217 };
2218
2219 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2220 are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2221
2222 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2223 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2224
2225 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr. */
2226 #define has_tls_get_addr_call sec_flg1
2227
2228 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2229 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2230
2231 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2232
2233 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2234 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
2235 == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
2236
2237 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2238
2239 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2240 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2241 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2242 const char *string)
2243 {
2244 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2245 subclass. */
2246 if (entry == NULL)
2247 {
2248 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2249 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2250 if (entry == NULL)
2251 return entry;
2252 }
2253
2254 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2255 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2256 if (entry != NULL)
2257 {
2258 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2259 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2260 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2261 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2262 }
2263
2264 return entry;
2265 }
2266
2267 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2268
2269 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2270 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2271 {
2272 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2273 static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2274 = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2275
2276 ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2277 if (ret == NULL)
2278 return NULL;
2279
2280 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2281 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2282 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2283 PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2284 {
2285 free (ret);
2286 return NULL;
2287 }
2288
2289 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2290 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2291 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2292 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2293
2294 ret->params = &default_params;
2295
2296 ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2297 ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2298 ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2299
2300 ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2301 ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2302 ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2303
2304 ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2305 ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2306 ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2307
2308 return &ret->elf.root;
2309 }
2310
2311 /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2312
2313 void
2314 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2315 {
2316 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2317
2318 if (htab)
2319 htab->params = params;
2320 params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2321 }
2322
2323 /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2324
2325 static bfd_boolean
2326 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2327 {
2328 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2329
2330 if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2331 return FALSE;
2332
2333 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2334 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
2335 {
2336 /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2337 executable. */
2338 flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2339 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2340 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2341 return FALSE;
2342 }
2343
2344 return TRUE;
2345 }
2346
2347 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2348 R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2349 and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2350
2351 static bfd_boolean
2352 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2353 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2354 flagword flags,
2355 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2356 {
2357 asection *s;
2358
2359 flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2360 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2361
2362 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2363 if (s == NULL)
2364 return FALSE;
2365 lsect->section = s;
2366
2367 /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2368 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2369
2370 lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2371 if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2372 return FALSE;
2373 lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2374 return TRUE;
2375 }
2376
2377 static bfd_boolean
2378 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2379 {
2380 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2381 asection *s;
2382 flagword flags;
2383 int p2align;
2384
2385 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2386 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2387 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2388 htab->glink = s;
2389 p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2390 if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2391 p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2392 if (s == NULL
2393 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, p2align))
2394 return FALSE;
2395
2396 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2397 {
2398 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2399 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2400 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2401 htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2402 if (s == NULL
2403 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2404 return FALSE;
2405 }
2406
2407 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2408 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2409 htab->elf.iplt = s;
2410 if (s == NULL
2411 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
2412 return FALSE;
2413
2414 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2415 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2416 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2417 htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2418 if (s == NULL
2419 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2420 return FALSE;
2421
2422 /* Local plt entries. */
2423 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2424 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2425 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2426 flags);
2427 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2428 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->pltlocal, 2))
2429 return FALSE;
2430
2431 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2432 {
2433 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2434 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2435 htab->relpltlocal
2436 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2437 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2438 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2439 return FALSE;
2440 }
2441
2442 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2443 &htab->sdata[0]))
2444 return FALSE;
2445
2446 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2447 &htab->sdata[1]))
2448 return FALSE;
2449
2450 return TRUE;
2451 }
2452
2453 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2454 to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2455 to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2456
2457 static bfd_boolean
2458 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2459 {
2460 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2461 asection *s;
2462 flagword flags;
2463
2464 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2465
2466 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2467 && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2468 return FALSE;
2469
2470 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2471 return FALSE;
2472
2473 if (htab->glink == NULL
2474 && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2475 return FALSE;
2476
2477 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2478 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2479 htab->dynsbss = s;
2480 if (s == NULL)
2481 return FALSE;
2482
2483 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2484 {
2485 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2486 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2487 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2488 htab->relsbss = s;
2489 if (s == NULL
2490 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2491 return FALSE;
2492 }
2493
2494 if (htab->is_vxworks
2495 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2496 return FALSE;
2497
2498 s = htab->elf.splt;
2499 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2500 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2501 /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2502 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2503 return bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags);
2504 }
2505
2506 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2507
2508 static void
2509 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2510 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2511 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2512 {
2513 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2514
2515 edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2516 eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2517
2518 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2519 edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2520
2521 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2522 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2523 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2524 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2525 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2526 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2527 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2528
2529 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2530 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2531 return;
2532
2533 if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2534 {
2535 if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2536 {
2537 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2538 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2539
2540 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2541 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2542 for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2543 {
2544 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2545
2546 for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2547 if (q->sec == p->sec)
2548 {
2549 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2550 q->count += p->count;
2551 *pp = p->next;
2552 break;
2553 }
2554 if (q == NULL)
2555 pp = &p->next;
2556 }
2557 *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
2558 }
2559
2560 edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
2561 eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2562 }
2563
2564 /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2565 the symbol which just became indirect. */
2566 edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2567 eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2568
2569 /* And plt entries. */
2570 if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2571 {
2572 if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2573 {
2574 struct plt_entry **entp;
2575 struct plt_entry *ent;
2576
2577 for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2578 {
2579 struct plt_entry *dent;
2580
2581 for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2582 if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2583 {
2584 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2585 *entp = ent->next;
2586 break;
2587 }
2588 if (dent == NULL)
2589 entp = &ent->next;
2590 }
2591 *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2592 }
2593
2594 edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2595 eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2596 }
2597
2598 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2599 {
2600 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2601 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2602 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2603 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2604 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2605 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2606 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2607 }
2608 }
2609
2610 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2611 file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2612
2613 static bfd_boolean
2614 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2615 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2616 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2617 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2618 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2619 asection **secp,
2620 bfd_vma *valp)
2621 {
2622 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2623 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2624 && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2625 && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2626 {
2627 /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2628 put into .sbss. */
2629 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2630
2631 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2632 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2633 {
2634 flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2635
2636 if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2637 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2638
2639 htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2640 ".sbss",
2641 flags);
2642 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2643 return FALSE;
2644 }
2645
2646 *secp = htab->sbss;
2647 *valp = sym->st_size;
2648 }
2649
2650 return TRUE;
2651 }
2652 \f
2653 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2654
2655 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2656 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2657 (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2658 bfd_vma addend,
2659 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2660 {
2661 for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2662 if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2663 return linker_pointers;
2664
2665 return NULL;
2666 }
2667
2668 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2669
2670 static bfd_boolean
2671 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2672 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2673 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2674 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2675 {
2676 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2677 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2678 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2679 bfd_size_type amt;
2680
2681 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2682
2683 /* Is this a global symbol? */
2684 if (h != NULL)
2685 {
2686 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2687
2688 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2689 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2690 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2691 rel->r_addend,
2692 lsect))
2693 return TRUE;
2694
2695 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2696 }
2697 else
2698 {
2699 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2700
2701 /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2702 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2703
2704 /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2705 if (!ptr)
2706 {
2707 unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2708
2709 amt = num_symbols;
2710 amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2711 ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2712
2713 if (!ptr)
2714 return FALSE;
2715
2716 elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2717 }
2718
2719 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2720 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2721 rel->r_addend,
2722 lsect))
2723 return TRUE;
2724
2725 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2726 }
2727
2728 /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2729 a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2730 BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2731 amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2732 linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2733
2734 if (!linker_section_ptr)
2735 return FALSE;
2736
2737 linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2738 linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2739 linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2740 *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2741
2742 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section->owner, lsect->section, 2))
2743 return FALSE;
2744 linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2745 lsect->section->size += 4;
2746
2747 #ifdef DEBUG
2748 fprintf (stderr,
2749 "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2750 lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2751 (long) lsect->section->size);
2752 #endif
2753
2754 return TRUE;
2755 }
2756
2757 static struct plt_entry **
2758 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2759 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2760 unsigned long r_symndx,
2761 int tls_type)
2762 {
2763 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2764 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2765 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2766
2767 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2768 {
2769 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2770
2771 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2772 + sizeof (*local_plt)
2773 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2774 local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2775 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2776 return NULL;
2777 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2778 }
2779
2780 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2781 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2782 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2783 if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2784 local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2785 return local_plt + r_symndx;
2786 }
2787
2788 static bfd_boolean
2789 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2790 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2791 {
2792 struct plt_entry *ent;
2793
2794 if (addend < 32768)
2795 sec = NULL;
2796 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2797 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2798 break;
2799 if (ent == NULL)
2800 {
2801 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
2802 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2803 if (ent == NULL)
2804 return FALSE;
2805 ent->next = *plist;
2806 ent->sec = sec;
2807 ent->addend = addend;
2808 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2809 *plist = ent;
2810 }
2811 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2812 return TRUE;
2813 }
2814
2815 static struct plt_entry *
2816 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2817 {
2818 struct plt_entry *ent;
2819
2820 if (addend < 32768)
2821 sec = NULL;
2822 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2823 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2824 break;
2825 return ent;
2826 }
2827
2828 static bfd_boolean
2829 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2830 {
2831 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2832 || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2833 || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2834 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2835 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2836 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2837 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2838 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2839 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2840 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2841 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2842 }
2843
2844 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2845
2846 static bfd_boolean
2847 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2848 {
2849 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2850 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2851 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2852 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2853 }
2854
2855 static void
2856 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2857 {
2858 _bfd_error_handler
2859 /* xgettext:c-format */
2860 (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2861 abfd,
2862 ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2863 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2864 }
2865
2866 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2867 allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2868 table. */
2869
2870 static bfd_boolean
2871 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2872 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2873 asection *sec,
2874 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2875 {
2876 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2877 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2878 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2879 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2880 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2881 asection *got2, *sreloc;
2882 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2883
2884 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2885 return TRUE;
2886
2887 /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
2888 In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
2889 and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
2890 or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
2891 relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
2892 libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate. */
2893 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2894 return TRUE;
2895
2896 #ifdef DEBUG
2897 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2898 sec, abfd);
2899 #endif
2900
2901 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2902
2903 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2904 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2905 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2906
2907 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2908 if (htab->glink == NULL)
2909 {
2910 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2911 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2912 if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2913 return FALSE;
2914 }
2915 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2916 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2917 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2918 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2919 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2920 sreloc = NULL;
2921
2922 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2923 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2924 {
2925 unsigned long r_symndx;
2926 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2927 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2928 int tls_type;
2929 struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2930 struct plt_entry **pltent;
2931 bfd_vma addend;
2932
2933 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2934 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2935 h = NULL;
2936 else
2937 {
2938 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2939 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2940 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2941 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2942 }
2943
2944 /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2945 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2946 startup code. */
2947 if (h != NULL
2948 && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2949 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2950 {
2951 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2952 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2953 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2954 return FALSE;
2955 BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2956 }
2957
2958 tls_type = 0;
2959 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2960 ifunc = NULL;
2961 if (h == NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
2962 {
2963 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2964 abfd, r_symndx);
2965 if (isym == NULL)
2966 return FALSE;
2967
2968 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2969 {
2970 /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2971 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2972 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2973 if (ifunc == NULL)
2974 return FALSE;
2975
2976 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2977 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2978 no plt calls. */
2979 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2980 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2981 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2982 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2983 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2984 {
2985 addend = 0;
2986 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2987 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2988 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2989 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2990 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2991 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2992 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2993 addend = rel->r_addend;
2994 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2995 return FALSE;
2996 }
2997 }
2998 }
2999
3000 if (!htab->is_vxworks
3001 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3002 && h != NULL
3003 && h == tga)
3004 {
3005 if (rel != relocs
3006 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3007 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3008 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3009 reloc. */
3010 ;
3011 else
3012 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3013 sec->has_tls_get_addr_call = 1;
3014 }
3015
3016 switch (r_type)
3017 {
3018 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3019 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3020 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3021 its parameter symbol. */
3022 if (h != NULL)
3023 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3024 else
3025 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3026 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3027 return FALSE;
3028 break;
3029
3030 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3031 break;
3032
3033 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3034 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3035 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3036 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3037 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3038 goto dogottls;
3039
3040 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3041 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3042 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3043 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3044 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3045 goto dogottls;
3046
3047 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3048 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3049 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3050 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3051 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3052 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3053 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3054 goto dogottls;
3055
3056 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3057 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3058 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3059 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3060 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3061 dogottls:
3062 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3063 /* Fall through. */
3064
3065 /* GOT16 relocations */
3066 case R_PPC_GOT16:
3067 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3068 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3069 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3070 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3071 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3072 {
3073 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3074 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3075 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3076 return FALSE;
3077 }
3078 if (h != NULL)
3079 {
3080 h->got.refcount += 1;
3081 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3082 }
3083 else
3084 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3085 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3086 return FALSE;
3087
3088 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3089 an ifunc. */
3090 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3091 {
3092 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3093 return FALSE;
3094 }
3095 break;
3096
3097 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3098 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3099 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3100 {
3101 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3102 return FALSE;
3103 }
3104 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3105 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3106 h, rel))
3107 return FALSE;
3108 if (h != NULL)
3109 {
3110 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3111 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3112 }
3113 break;
3114
3115 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3116 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3117 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3118 {
3119 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3120 return FALSE;
3121 }
3122 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3123 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3124 h, rel))
3125 return FALSE;
3126 if (h != NULL)
3127 {
3128 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3129 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3130 }
3131 break;
3132
3133 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3134 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3135 /* Fall through. */
3136
3137 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3138 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3139 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3140 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3141 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3142 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3143 if (h != NULL)
3144 {
3145 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3146 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3147 }
3148 break;
3149
3150 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3151 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3152 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3153 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3154 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3155 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3156 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3157 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3158 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3159 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3160 break;
3161
3162 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3163 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3164 {
3165 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3166 return FALSE;
3167 }
3168 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3169 if (h != NULL)
3170 {
3171 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3172 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3173 }
3174 break;
3175
3176 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3177 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3178 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3179 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3180 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3181 {
3182 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3183 return FALSE;
3184 }
3185 if (h != NULL)
3186 {
3187 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3188 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3189 }
3190 break;
3191
3192 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3193 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3194 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3195 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3196 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3197 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3198 {
3199 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3200 return FALSE;
3201 }
3202 if (h != NULL)
3203 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3204 break;
3205
3206 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3207 if (h == NULL)
3208 break;
3209 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3210 goto pltentry;
3211
3212 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3213 sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3214 /* Fall through. */
3215
3216 case R_PPC_PLT32:
3217 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3218 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3219 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3220 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3221 pltentry:
3222 #ifdef DEBUG
3223 fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3224 #endif
3225 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3226 if (h == NULL)
3227 {
3228 pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3229 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3230 if (pltent == NULL)
3231 return FALSE;
3232 }
3233 else
3234 {
3235 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3236 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3237 h->needs_plt = 1;
3238 pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3239 }
3240 addend = 0;
3241 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3242 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3243 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3244 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3245 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3246 addend = rel->r_addend;
3247 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3248 return FALSE;
3249 break;
3250
3251 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3252 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3253 section relative. */
3254 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3255 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3256 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3257 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3258 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3259 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3260 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3261 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3262 case R_PPC_TOC16:
3263 break;
3264
3265 case R_PPC_REL16:
3266 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3267 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3268 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3269 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3270 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3271 break;
3272
3273 /* These are just markers. */
3274 case R_PPC_TLS:
3275 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3276 case R_PPC_NONE:
3277 case R_PPC_max:
3278 case R_PPC_RELAX:
3279 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3280 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3281 case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3282 break;
3283
3284 /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3285 case R_PPC_COPY:
3286 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3287 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3288 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3289 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3290 break;
3291
3292 /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3293 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3294 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3295 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3296 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3297 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3298 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3299 break;
3300
3301 /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3302 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3303 if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3304 {
3305 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3306 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3307 }
3308 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3309 {
3310 h->needs_plt = 1;
3311 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3312 return FALSE;
3313 }
3314 break;
3315
3316 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3317 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3318 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3319 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3320 return FALSE;
3321 break;
3322
3323 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3324 used. Record for later use during GC. */
3325 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3326 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3327 return FALSE;
3328 break;
3329
3330 /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3331 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3332 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3333 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3334 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3335 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3336 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3337 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3338 goto dodyn;
3339
3340 /* Nor these. */
3341 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3342 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3343 goto dodyn;
3344
3345 case R_PPC_REL32:
3346 if (h == NULL
3347 && got2 != NULL
3348 && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3349 && bfd_link_pic (info)
3350 && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3351 {
3352 /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3353 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3354 reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3355 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3356 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3357 PLT call stubs. */
3358 asection *s;
3359 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3360
3361 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3362 abfd, r_symndx);
3363 if (isym == NULL)
3364 return FALSE;
3365
3366 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3367 if (s == got2)
3368 {
3369 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3370 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3371 }
3372 }
3373 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3374 break;
3375 /* fall through */
3376
3377 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3378 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3379 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3380 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3381 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3382 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3383 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3384 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3385 {
3386 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3387 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3388 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3389 return FALSE;
3390
3391 /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3392 h->non_got_ref = 1;
3393 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3394 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3395 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3396 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3397 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3398 }
3399 goto dodyn;
3400
3401 case R_PPC_REL24:
3402 case R_PPC_REL14:
3403 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3404 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3405 if (h == NULL)
3406 break;
3407 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3408 {
3409 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3410 {
3411 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3412 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3413 }
3414 break;
3415 }
3416 /* fall through */
3417
3418 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3419 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3420 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3421 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3422 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3423 {
3424 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3425 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3426 h->needs_plt = 1;
3427 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3428 return FALSE;
3429 break;
3430 }
3431
3432 dodyn:
3433 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3434 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3435 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3436 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
3437 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3438 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3439 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
3440 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3441 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3442 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
3443 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3444 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
3445 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3446 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
3447 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3448 symbol local.
3449
3450 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3451 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3452 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3453 symbol. */
3454 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3455 && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3456 || (h != NULL
3457 && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3458 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3459 || !h->def_regular))))
3460 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3461 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3462 && h != NULL
3463 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3464 || !h->def_regular)))
3465 {
3466 #ifdef DEBUG
3467 fprintf (stderr,
3468 "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3469 "create relocation for %s\n",
3470 (h && h->root.root.string
3471 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3472 #endif
3473 if (sreloc == NULL)
3474 {
3475 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3476 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3477
3478 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3479 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3480
3481 if (sreloc == NULL)
3482 return FALSE;
3483 }
3484
3485 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3486 relocations we need for this symbol. */
3487 if (h != NULL)
3488 {
3489 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3490 struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3491
3492 rel_head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
3493 p = *rel_head;
3494 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3495 {
3496 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3497 if (p == NULL)
3498 return FALSE;
3499 p->next = *rel_head;
3500 *rel_head = p;
3501 p->sec = sec;
3502 p->count = 0;
3503 p->pc_count = 0;
3504 }
3505 p->count += 1;
3506 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3507 p->pc_count += 1;
3508 }
3509 else
3510 {
3511 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3512 We really need local syms available to do this
3513 easily. Oh well. */
3514 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3515 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3516 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3517 asection *s;
3518 void *vpp;
3519 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3520
3521 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3522 abfd, r_symndx);
3523 if (isym == NULL)
3524 return FALSE;
3525
3526 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3527 if (s == NULL)
3528 s = sec;
3529
3530 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3531 rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3532 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3533 p = *rel_head;
3534 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3535 p = p->next;
3536 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3537 {
3538 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3539 if (p == NULL)
3540 return FALSE;
3541 p->next = *rel_head;
3542 *rel_head = p;
3543 p->sec = sec;
3544 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3545 p->count = 0;
3546 }
3547 p->count += 1;
3548 }
3549 }
3550
3551 break;
3552 }
3553 }
3554
3555 return TRUE;
3556 }
3557 \f
3558 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3559 and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3560 bfd_boolean
3561 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3562 {
3563 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3564 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3565 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3566 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3567
3568 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3569 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3570
3571 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3572 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3573
3574 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3575 {
3576 int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3577 int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3578 static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3579
3580 if (in_fp == 0)
3581 ;
3582 else if (out_fp == 0)
3583 {
3584 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3585 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3586 last_fp = ibfd;
3587 }
3588 else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3589 {
3590 _bfd_error_handler
3591 /* xgettext:c-format */
3592 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3593 last_fp, ibfd);
3594 ret = FALSE;
3595 }
3596 else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3597 {
3598 _bfd_error_handler
3599 /* xgettext:c-format */
3600 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3601 ibfd, last_fp);
3602 ret = FALSE;
3603 }
3604 else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3605 {
3606 _bfd_error_handler
3607 /* xgettext:c-format */
3608 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3609 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3610 ret = FALSE;
3611 }
3612 else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3613 {
3614 _bfd_error_handler
3615 /* xgettext:c-format */
3616 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3617 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3618 ret = FALSE;
3619 }
3620
3621 in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3622 out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3623 if (in_fp == 0)
3624 ;
3625 else if (out_fp == 0)
3626 {
3627 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3628 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3629 last_ld = ibfd;
3630 }
3631 else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3632 {
3633 _bfd_error_handler
3634 /* xgettext:c-format */
3635 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3636 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3637 ret = FALSE;
3638 }
3639 else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3640 {
3641 _bfd_error_handler
3642 /* xgettext:c-format */
3643 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3644 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3645 ret = FALSE;
3646 }
3647 else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3648 {
3649 _bfd_error_handler
3650 /* xgettext:c-format */
3651 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3652 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3653 ret = FALSE;
3654 }
3655 else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3656 {
3657 _bfd_error_handler
3658 /* xgettext:c-format */
3659 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3660 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3661 ret = FALSE;
3662 }
3663 }
3664
3665 if (!ret)
3666 {
3667 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3668 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3669 }
3670 return ret;
3671 }
3672
3673 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3674 there are conflicting attributes. */
3675 static bfd_boolean
3676 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3677 {
3678 bfd *obfd;
3679 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3680 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3681 bfd_boolean ret;
3682
3683 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3684 return FALSE;
3685
3686 obfd = info->output_bfd;
3687 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3688 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3689
3690 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3691 merge non-conflicting ones. */
3692 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3693 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3694 ret = TRUE;
3695 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3696 {
3697 int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3698 int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3699 static bfd *last_vec;
3700
3701 if (in_vec == 0)
3702 ;
3703 else if (out_vec == 0)
3704 {
3705 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3706 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3707 last_vec = ibfd;
3708 }
3709 /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3710 without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3711 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3712 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3713 case too. */
3714 else if (in_vec == 1)
3715 ;
3716 else if (out_vec == 1)
3717 {
3718 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3719 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3720 last_vec = ibfd;
3721 }
3722 else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3723 {
3724 _bfd_error_handler
3725 /* xgettext:c-format */
3726 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3727 last_vec, ibfd);
3728 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3729 ret = FALSE;
3730 }
3731 else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3732 {
3733 _bfd_error_handler
3734 /* xgettext:c-format */
3735 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3736 ibfd, last_vec);
3737 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3738 ret = FALSE;
3739 }
3740 }
3741
3742 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3743 and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3744 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3745 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3746 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3747 {
3748 int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3749 int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3750 static bfd *last_struct;
3751
3752 if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3753 ;
3754 else if (out_struct == 0)
3755 {
3756 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3757 out_attr->i = in_struct;
3758 last_struct = ibfd;
3759 }
3760 else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3761 {
3762 _bfd_error_handler
3763 /* xgettext:c-format */
3764 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3765 "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3766 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3767 ret = FALSE;
3768 }
3769 else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3770 {
3771 _bfd_error_handler
3772 /* xgettext:c-format */
3773 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3774 "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3775 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3776 ret = FALSE;
3777 }
3778 }
3779 if (!ret)
3780 {
3781 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3782 return FALSE;
3783 }
3784
3785 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3786 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3787 }
3788
3789 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3790 object file when linking. */
3791
3792 static bfd_boolean
3793 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3794 {
3795 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3796 flagword old_flags;
3797 flagword new_flags;
3798 bfd_boolean error;
3799
3800 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3801 return TRUE;
3802
3803 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3804 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3805 return FALSE;
3806
3807 if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3808 return FALSE;
3809
3810 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3811 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3812 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3813 {
3814 /* First call, no flags set. */
3815 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3816 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3817 }
3818
3819 /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3820 else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3821 ;
3822
3823 /* Incompatible flags. */
3824 else
3825 {
3826 /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3827 to be linked with either. */
3828 error = FALSE;
3829 if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3830 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3831 {
3832 error = TRUE;
3833 _bfd_error_handler
3834 (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3835 "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3836 }
3837 else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3838 && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3839 {
3840 error = TRUE;
3841 _bfd_error_handler
3842 (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3843 "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3844 }
3845
3846 /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3847 if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3848 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3849
3850 /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3851 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3852 if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3853 && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3854 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3855 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3856
3857 /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3858 any module uses it. */
3859 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3860
3861 new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3862 old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3863
3864 /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3865 if (new_flags != old_flags)
3866 {
3867 error = TRUE;
3868 _bfd_error_handler
3869 /* xgettext:c-format */
3870 (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3871 "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3872 ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3873 }
3874
3875 if (error)
3876 {
3877 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3878 return FALSE;
3879 }
3880 }
3881
3882 return TRUE;
3883 }
3884
3885 static void
3886 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3887 asection *input_section,
3888 unsigned long offset,
3889 bfd_byte *loc,
3890 bfd_vma value,
3891 split16_format_type split16_format,
3892 bfd_boolean fixup)
3893 {
3894 unsigned int insn, opcode;
3895
3896 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3897 opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3898 if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3899 || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3900 || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3901 || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3902 || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3903 {
3904 if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3905 {
3906 if (fixup)
3907 split16_format = split16a_type;
3908 else
3909 _bfd_error_handler
3910 /* xgettext:c-format */
3911 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3912 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3913 }
3914 }
3915 else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3916 || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3917 || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3918 || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3919 || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3920 || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3921 || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3922 {
3923 if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3924 {
3925 if (fixup)
3926 split16_format = split16d_type;
3927 else
3928 _bfd_error_handler
3929 /* xgettext:c-format */
3930 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3931 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3932 }
3933 }
3934 if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3935 {
3936 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3937 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3938 if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3939 {
3940 /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3941 insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3942 insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3943 }
3944 }
3945 else
3946 {
3947 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3948 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3949 }
3950 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3951 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3952 }
3953
3954 static void
3955 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3956 {
3957 unsigned int insn;
3958
3959 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3960 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3961 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3962 insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3963 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3964 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3965 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3966 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3967 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3968 }
3969
3970 \f
3971 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3972 Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3973 int
3974 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3975 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3976 {
3977 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3978 flagword flags;
3979
3980 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3981
3982 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3983 {
3984 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3985
3986 if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3987 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3988 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3989 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3990 && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3991 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3992 && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3993 || h->needs_plt)
3994 && h->ref_regular
3995 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3996 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3997 {
3998 /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3999 secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
4000 function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
4001 r30 to be set up. */
4002 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4003 }
4004 else
4005 {
4006 bfd *ibfd;
4007 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
4008
4009 /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
4010 Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4011 without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4012 --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
4013 if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4014 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4015 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4016 if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4017 {
4018 if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4019 plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4020 else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4021 {
4022 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4023 htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4024 break;
4025 }
4026 }
4027 htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4028 }
4029 }
4030 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4031 {
4032 if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4033 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4034 else
4035 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4036 }
4037
4038 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4039
4040 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4041 {
4042 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4043 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4044
4045 /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4046 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4047 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.splt, flags))
4048 return -1;
4049
4050 /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4051 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4052 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4053 return -1;
4054 }
4055 else
4056 {
4057 /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4058 if (htab->glink != NULL
4059 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink, 0))
4060 return -1;
4061 }
4062 return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4063 }
4064 \f
4065 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4066 relocation. */
4067
4068 static asection *
4069 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4070 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4071 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4072 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4073 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4074 {
4075 if (h != NULL)
4076 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4077 {
4078 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4079 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4080 return NULL;
4081 }
4082
4083 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4084 }
4085
4086 static bfd_boolean
4087 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4088 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4089 asection **symsecp,
4090 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4091 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4092 unsigned long r_symndx,
4093 bfd *ibfd)
4094 {
4095 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4096
4097 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4098 {
4099 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4100 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4101
4102 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4103 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4104 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4105 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4106
4107 if (hp != NULL)
4108 *hp = h;
4109
4110 if (symp != NULL)
4111 *symp = NULL;
4112
4113 if (symsecp != NULL)
4114 {
4115 asection *symsec = NULL;
4116 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4117 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4118 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4119 *symsecp = symsec;
4120 }
4121
4122 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4123 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4124 }
4125 else
4126 {
4127 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4128 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4129
4130 if (locsyms == NULL)
4131 {
4132 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4133 if (locsyms == NULL)
4134 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4135 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4136 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4137 if (locsyms == NULL)
4138 return FALSE;
4139 *locsymsp = locsyms;
4140 }
4141 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4142
4143 if (hp != NULL)
4144 *hp = NULL;
4145
4146 if (symp != NULL)
4147 *symp = sym;
4148
4149 if (symsecp != NULL)
4150 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4151
4152 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4153 {
4154 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4155 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4156
4157 tls_mask = NULL;
4158 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4159 if (local_got != NULL)
4160 {
4161 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4162 (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4163 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4164 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4165 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4166 }
4167 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4168 }
4169 }
4170 return TRUE;
4171 }
4172 \f
4173 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4174 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4175
4176 bfd_boolean
4177 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4178 {
4179 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4180 bfd *ibfd;
4181 asection *sec;
4182 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4183
4184 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4185 if (htab == NULL)
4186 return FALSE;
4187
4188 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4189 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4190 between the call and its destination. */
4191 limit = 0x1e00000;
4192 low_vma = -1;
4193 high_vma = 0;
4194 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4195 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4196 {
4197 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4198 low_vma = sec->vma;
4199 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4200 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4201 }
4202
4203 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4204 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4205 is local. */
4206 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4207 {
4208 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4209 return TRUE;
4210 }
4211
4212 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4213 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4214 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4215 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4216 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4217 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4218 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4219 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4220 particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4221 call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4222 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4223 together except their symbol. */
4224
4225 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4226 {
4227 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4228 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4229
4230 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4231 continue;
4232
4233 local_syms = NULL;
4234 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4235
4236 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4237 if (sec->has_pltcall
4238 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4239 {
4240 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4241
4242 /* Read the relocations. */
4243 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4244 info->keep_memory);
4245 if (relstart == NULL)
4246 return FALSE;
4247
4248 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4249 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
4250 {
4251 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4252 unsigned long r_symndx;
4253 asection *sym_sec;
4254 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4255 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4256 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4257
4258 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4259 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4260 continue;
4261
4262 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4263 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4264 r_symndx, ibfd))
4265 {
4266 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4267 free (relstart);
4268 if (local_syms != NULL
4269 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4270 free (local_syms);
4271 return FALSE;
4272 }
4273
4274 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4275 {
4276 bfd_vma from, to;
4277 if (h != NULL)
4278 to = h->root.u.def.value;
4279 else
4280 to = sym->st_value;
4281 to += (rel->r_addend
4282 + sym_sec->output_offset
4283 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4284 from = (rel->r_offset
4285 + sec->output_offset
4286 + sec->output_section->vma);
4287 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4288 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4289 }
4290 }
4291 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4292 free (relstart);
4293 }
4294
4295 if (local_syms != NULL
4296 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4297 {
4298 if (!info->keep_memory)
4299 free (local_syms);
4300 else
4301 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4302 }
4303 }
4304
4305 return TRUE;
4306 }
4307
4308 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4309 generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4310
4311 asection *
4312 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4313 {
4314 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4315
4316 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4317 htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4318 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4319 if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4320 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4321
4322 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4323 {
4324 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4325 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4326 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4327 if (opt != NULL
4328 && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4329 || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4330 {
4331 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4332 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4333 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4334 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4335 tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4336 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4337 && tga != NULL
4338 && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4339 || tga->needs_plt)
4340 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4341 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4342 {
4343 struct plt_entry *ent;
4344 for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4345 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4346 break;
4347 if (ent != NULL)
4348 {
4349 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4350 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4351 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4352 opt->mark = 1;
4353 if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4354 {
4355 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4356 opt->dynindx = -1;
4357 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4358 opt->dynstr_index);
4359 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4360 return FALSE;
4361 }
4362 htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4363 }
4364 }
4365 }
4366 else
4367 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4368 }
4369 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4370 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4371 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4372 {
4373 elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4374 elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4375 }
4376
4377 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4378 }
4379
4380 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4381 HASH. */
4382
4383 static bfd_boolean
4384 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4385 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4386 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4387 {
4388 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4389 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4390 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4391
4392 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4393 {
4394 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4395 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4396
4397 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4398 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4399 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4400 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4401 if (h == hash)
4402 return TRUE;
4403 }
4404 return FALSE;
4405 }
4406
4407 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4408 opportunities. */
4409
4410 bfd_boolean
4411 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4412 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4413 {
4414 bfd *ibfd;
4415 asection *sec;
4416 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4417 int pass;
4418
4419 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4420 return TRUE;
4421
4422 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4423 if (htab == NULL)
4424 return FALSE;
4425
4426 /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4427 relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4428 followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4429 optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4430 notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4431 adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4432 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4433 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4434 {
4435 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4436 asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4437
4438 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4439 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4440 {
4441 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4442 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4443
4444 /* Read the relocations. */
4445 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4446 info->keep_memory);
4447 if (relstart == NULL)
4448 return FALSE;
4449
4450 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4451 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4452 {
4453 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4454 unsigned long r_symndx;
4455 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4456 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4457 unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4458 bfd_boolean is_local;
4459 bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4460
4461 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4462 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4463 {
4464 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4465
4466 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4467 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4468 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4469 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4470 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4471 }
4472
4473 is_local = FALSE;
4474 if (h == NULL
4475 || !h->def_dynamic)
4476 is_local = TRUE;
4477
4478 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4479 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4480 without marker relocs, then check that each
4481 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4482 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4483 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4484 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4485 if (pass == 0
4486 && sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4487 && h != NULL
4488 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4489 && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4490 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4491 {
4492 info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4493 "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4494 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4495 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4496 free (relstart);
4497 return TRUE;
4498 }
4499
4500 expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4501 switch (r_type)
4502 {
4503 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4504 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4505 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4506 /* Fall through. */
4507
4508 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4509 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4510 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4511 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4512 that turns out to be the case. */
4513 if (!is_local)
4514 continue;
4515
4516 /* LD -> LE */
4517 tls_set = 0;
4518 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4519 break;
4520
4521 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4522 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4523 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4524 /* Fall through. */
4525
4526 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4527 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4528 if (is_local)
4529 /* GD -> LE */
4530 tls_set = 0;
4531 else
4532 /* GD -> IE */
4533 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4534 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4535 break;
4536
4537 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4538 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4539 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4540 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4541 if (is_local)
4542 {
4543 /* IE -> LE */
4544 tls_set = 0;
4545 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4546 break;
4547 }
4548 else
4549 continue;
4550
4551 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4552 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4553 if (rel + 1 < relend
4554 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4555 {
4556 if (pass != 0
4557 && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4558 {
4559 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4560 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4561 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4562 {
4563 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4564
4565 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4566 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4567 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4568 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4569 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4570 if (h != NULL)
4571 {
4572 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4573 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4574
4575 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4576 addend = rel->r_addend;
4577 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4578 got2, addend);
4579 if (ent != NULL
4580 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4581 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4582 }
4583 }
4584 }
4585 continue;
4586 }
4587 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4588 tls_set = 0;
4589 tls_clear = 0;
4590 break;
4591
4592 default:
4593 continue;
4594 }
4595
4596 if (pass == 0)
4597 {
4598 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4599 || !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call)
4600 continue;
4601
4602 if (rel + 1 < relend
4603 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4604 htab->tls_get_addr))
4605 continue;
4606
4607 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4608 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4609 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4610 the entire optimization. */
4611 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4612 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4613 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4614 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4615 free (relstart);
4616 return TRUE;
4617 }
4618
4619 if (h != NULL)
4620 {
4621 tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4622 got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4623 }
4624 else
4625 {
4626 bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4627 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4628 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4629
4630 lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4631 if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4632 abort ();
4633 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4634 (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4635 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4636 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4637 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4638 got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4639 }
4640
4641 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4642 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4643 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4644 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4645 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4646 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4647 Disable optimization in this case. */
4648 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4649 && !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4650 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4651 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4652 continue;
4653
4654 if (expecting_tls_get_addr)
4655 {
4656 struct plt_entry *ent;
4657 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4658
4659 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4660 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4661 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4662 addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4663 ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4664 got2, addend);
4665 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4666 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4667
4668 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
4669 continue;
4670 }
4671
4672 if (tls_set == 0)
4673 {
4674 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4675 if (*got_count > 0)
4676 *got_count -= 1;
4677 }
4678
4679 *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4680 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4681 }
4682
4683 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4684 free (relstart);
4685 }
4686 }
4687 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4688 return TRUE;
4689 }
4690 \f
4691 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections. */
4692
4693 static asection *
4694 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4695 {
4696 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4697
4698 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4699 {
4700 asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
4701
4702 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4703 return p->sec;
4704 }
4705 return NULL;
4706 }
4707
4708 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4709 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4710 size_dynamic_sections. */
4711
4712 static bfd_boolean
4713 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4714 {
4715 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4716 do
4717 {
4718 if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4719 return TRUE;
4720 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4721 } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4722
4723 return FALSE;
4724 }
4725
4726 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4727
4728 static bfd_boolean
4729 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4730 {
4731 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4732
4733 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4734 if (p->pc_count != 0)
4735 return TRUE;
4736 return FALSE;
4737 }
4738
4739 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4740 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4741 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4742 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4743 understand. */
4744
4745 static bfd_boolean
4746 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4747 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4748 {
4749 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4750 asection *s;
4751
4752 #ifdef DEBUG
4753 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4754 h->root.root.string);
4755 #endif
4756
4757 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4758 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4759 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4760 && (h->needs_plt
4761 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4762 || h->is_weakalias
4763 || (h->def_dynamic
4764 && h->ref_regular
4765 && !h->def_regular)));
4766
4767 /* Deal with function syms. */
4768 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4769 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4770 || h->needs_plt)
4771 {
4772 bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4773 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4774 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4775 function symbol is local. */
4776 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4777 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4778
4779 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4780 won't need a .plt entry. */
4781 struct plt_entry *ent;
4782 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4783 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4784 break;
4785 if (ent == NULL
4786 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4787 && local
4788 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4789 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4790 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4791 {
4792 /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4793
4794 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4795 can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4796 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4797
4798 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4799
4800 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4801 will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4802 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4803 h->needs_plt = 0;
4804 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4805 }
4806 else
4807 {
4808 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4809 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4810 executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4811 be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4812 (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4813 through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4814 reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4815 resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4816 than link time. */
4817 if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4818 || (h->non_got_ref
4819 && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4820 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4821 && !htab->is_vxworks
4822 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4823 && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4824 {
4825 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4826 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4827 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4828 if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4829 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4830 }
4831 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4832 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4833 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4834 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4835 }
4836 h->protected_def = 0;
4837 /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4838 return TRUE;
4839 }
4840 else
4841 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4842
4843 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4844 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4845 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4846 if (h->is_weakalias)
4847 {
4848 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4849 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4850 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4851 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4852 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4853 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4854 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4855 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4856 return TRUE;
4857 }
4858
4859 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4860 is not a function. */
4861
4862 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4863 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4864 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4865 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4866 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4867 {
4868 h->protected_def = 0;
4869 return TRUE;
4870 }
4871
4872 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4873 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4874 if (!h->non_got_ref)
4875 {
4876 h->protected_def = 0;
4877 return TRUE;
4878 }
4879
4880 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4881 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4882 definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4883 are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4884 if (h->protected_def)
4885 {
4886 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4887 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4888 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4889 && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4890 && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4891 htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4892 return TRUE;
4893 }
4894
4895 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4896 if (info->nocopyreloc)
4897 return TRUE;
4898
4899 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4900 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4901 We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4902 doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4903 relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4904 executable. */
4905 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4906 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4907 && !htab->is_vxworks
4908 && !h->def_regular
4909 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4910 return TRUE;
4911
4912 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4913 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4914 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4915 object will contain position independent code, so all references
4916 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4917 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4918 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4919 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4920 same memory location for the variable.
4921
4922 Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4923 must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4924 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4925 s = htab->dynsbss;
4926 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4927 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4928 else
4929 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4930 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4931
4932 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4933 {
4934 asection *srel;
4935
4936 /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4937 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4938 and into the runtime process image. */
4939 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4940 srel = htab->relsbss;
4941 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4942 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4943 else
4944 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4945 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4946 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4947 h->needs_copy = 1;
4948 }
4949
4950 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4951 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4952 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4953 }
4954 \f
4955 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4956 xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4957 specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4958 is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4959 xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4960
4961 static bfd_boolean
4962 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4963 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4964 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4965 {
4966 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4967 size_t len1, len2, len3;
4968 char *name;
4969 const char *stub;
4970 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4971
4972 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4973 stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4974 else
4975 stub = ".plt_call32.";
4976
4977 len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4978 len2 = strlen (stub);
4979 len3 = 0;
4980 if (ent->sec)
4981 len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4982 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4983 if (name == NULL)
4984 return FALSE;
4985 sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4986 if (ent->sec)
4987 memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4988 memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4989 memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4990 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
4991 if (sh == NULL)
4992 return FALSE;
4993 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
4994 {
4995 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
4996 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
4997 sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
4998 sh->ref_regular = 1;
4999 sh->def_regular = 1;
5000 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5001 sh->forced_local = 1;
5002 sh->non_elf = 0;
5003 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5004 }
5005 return TRUE;
5006 }
5007
5008 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
5009 Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
5010
5011 static bfd_vma
5012 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
5013 {
5014 bfd_vma where;
5015 unsigned int max_before_header;
5016
5017 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5018 {
5019 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5020 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5021 }
5022 else
5023 {
5024 max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5025 if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5026 {
5027 where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5028 htab->got_gap -= need;
5029 }
5030 else
5031 {
5032 if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5033 && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5034 {
5035 htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5036 htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5037 }
5038 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5039 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5040 }
5041 }
5042 return where;
5043 }
5044
5045 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5046 TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5047
5048 static inline unsigned int
5049 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5050 {
5051 unsigned int need;
5052 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5053 need = 4;
5054 else
5055 {
5056 need = 0;
5057 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5058 need += 8;
5059 if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5060 need += 4;
5061 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5062 need += 4;
5063 }
5064 return need;
5065 }
5066
5067 /* Calculate size of relocs needed for symbol given its TLS_MASK and
5068 NEEDed GOT entries. KNOWN says a TPREL offset can be calculated at
5069 link time. */
5070
5071 static inline unsigned int
5072 got_relocs_needed (int tls_mask, unsigned int need, bfd_boolean known)
5073 {
5074 /* All the entries we allocated need relocs.
5075 Except IE in executable with a local symbol. We could also omit
5076 the DTPREL reloc on the second word of a GD entry under the same
5077 condition as that for IE, but ld.so needs to differentiate
5078 LD and GD entries. */
5079 if (known && (tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5080 && (tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5081 need -= 4;
5082 return need * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5083 }
5084
5085 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5086
5087 static bfd_boolean
5088 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5089 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5090 {
5091 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5092
5093 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5094 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5095 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5096 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5097 && h->dynindx == -1
5098 && !h->forced_local
5099 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5100 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5101 return TRUE;
5102 }
5103
5104 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5105
5106 static bfd_boolean
5107 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5108 {
5109 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5110 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5111 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5112 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5113 bfd_boolean dyn;
5114
5115 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5116 return TRUE;
5117
5118 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5119 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5120 if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5121 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5122 && !eh->elf.def_regular
5123 && eh->elf.protected_def
5124 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5125 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5126 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5127 {
5128 unsigned int need;
5129
5130 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5131 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5132 return FALSE;
5133
5134 need = 0;
5135 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5136 {
5137 if (!eh->elf.def_dynamic)
5138 /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5139 always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5140 a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5141 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5142 else
5143 need += 8;
5144 }
5145 need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5146 if (need == 0)
5147 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5148 else
5149 {
5150 eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5151 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
5152 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5153 && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5154 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5155 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5156 {
5157 asection *rsec;
5158 bfd_boolean tprel_known = (bfd_link_executable (info)
5159 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info,
5160 &eh->elf));
5161
5162 need = got_relocs_needed (eh->tls_mask, need, tprel_known);
5163 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
5164 && eh->elf.def_dynamic)
5165 need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5166 rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5167 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5168 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5169 rsec->size += need;
5170 }
5171 }
5172 }
5173 else
5174 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5175
5176 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5177 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5178 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5179 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5180 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5181
5182 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5183 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5184 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5185 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5186
5187 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5188 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5189 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5190 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5191
5192 if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5193 ;
5194
5195 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5196 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5197 defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5198 space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5199 changes. */
5200 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5201 {
5202 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5203 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5204 generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5205 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5206 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5207 then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5208 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5209 {
5210 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5211
5212 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5213 {
5214 p->count -= p->pc_count;
5215 p->pc_count = 0;
5216 if (p->count == 0)
5217 *pp = p->next;
5218 else
5219 pp = &p->next;
5220 }
5221 }
5222
5223 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5224 {
5225 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5226
5227 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5228 {
5229 if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5230 *pp = p->next;
5231 else
5232 pp = &p->next;
5233 }
5234 }
5235
5236 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5237 {
5238 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5239 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5240 return FALSE;
5241 }
5242 }
5243 else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5244 {
5245 /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5246 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5247 dynamic. */
5248 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5249 && !h->def_regular
5250 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5251 && !(h->protected_def
5252 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5253 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5254 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5255 {
5256 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5257 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5258 return FALSE;
5259
5260 if (h->dynindx == -1)
5261 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5262 }
5263 else
5264 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5265 }
5266
5267 /* Allocate space. */
5268 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5269 {
5270 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5271 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5272 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5273 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5274 }
5275
5276 /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5277 We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5278 a) is dynamic, or
5279 b) is an ifunc, or
5280 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5281 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5282 dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5283 if (dyn
5284 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5285 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5286 || (h->needs_plt
5287 && h->def_regular
5288 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5289 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5290 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5291 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5292 {
5293 struct plt_entry *ent;
5294 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5295 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5296
5297 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5298 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5299 {
5300 asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5301
5302 if (!dyn)
5303 {
5304 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5305 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5306 else
5307 s = htab->pltlocal;
5308 }
5309
5310 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5311 {
5312 if (!doneone)
5313 {
5314 plt_offset = s->size;
5315 s->size += 4;
5316 }
5317 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5318
5319 if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5320 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5321 else
5322 {
5323 s = htab->glink;
5324 if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5325 {
5326 glink_offset = s->size;
5327 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5328 }
5329 if (!doneone
5330 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5331 && h->def_dynamic
5332 && !h->def_regular)
5333 {
5334 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5335 h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5336 }
5337 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5338
5339 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5340 && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5341 return FALSE;
5342 }
5343 }
5344 else
5345 {
5346 if (!doneone)
5347 {
5348 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5349 for the special first entry. */
5350 if (s->size == 0)
5351 s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5352
5353 /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5354 parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5355 and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5356 word available at the end. */
5357 plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5358 + (htab->plt_slot_size
5359 * ((s->size
5360 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5361 / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5362
5363 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5364 file, and we are not generating a shared
5365 library, then set the symbol to this location
5366 in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5367 relocations, and is required to make
5368 function pointers compare as equal between
5369 the normal executable and the shared library. */
5370 if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5371 && h->def_dynamic
5372 && !h->def_regular)
5373 {
5374 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5375 h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5376 }
5377
5378 /* Make room for this entry. */
5379 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5380 /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5381 is allocated. */
5382 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5383 && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5384 / htab->plt_entry_size
5385 > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5386 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5387 }
5388 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5389 }
5390
5391 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5392 if (!doneone)
5393 {
5394 if (!dyn)
5395 {
5396 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5397 {
5398 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5399 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5400 }
5401 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5402 {
5403 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5404 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5405 }
5406 }
5407 else
5408 {
5409 htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5410
5411 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5412 {
5413 /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5414 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5415 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5416 {
5417 if (ent->plt.offset
5418 == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5419 {
5420 htab->srelplt2->size
5421 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5422 * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5423 }
5424
5425 htab->srelplt2->size
5426 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5427 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5428 }
5429
5430 /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5431 .got.plt. */
5432 htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5433 }
5434 }
5435 doneone = TRUE;
5436 }
5437 }
5438 else
5439 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5440
5441 if (!doneone)
5442 {
5443 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5444 h->needs_plt = 0;
5445 }
5446 }
5447 else
5448 {
5449 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5450 h->needs_plt = 0;
5451 }
5452
5453 return TRUE;
5454 }
5455
5456 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
5457 read-only sections. */
5458
5459 static bfd_boolean
5460 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *info_p)
5461 {
5462 asection *sec;
5463
5464 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5465 return TRUE;
5466
5467 sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
5468 if (sec != NULL)
5469 {
5470 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) info_p;
5471
5472 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5473 info->callbacks->minfo
5474 (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT' in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5475 sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
5476
5477 /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
5478 return FALSE;
5479 }
5480 return TRUE;
5481 }
5482
5483 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5484 {
5485 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5486 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5487 1, /* CIE version. */
5488 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5489 4, /* Code alignment. */
5490 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5491 65, /* RA reg. */
5492 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5493 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5494 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5495 };
5496
5497 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5498
5499 static bfd_boolean
5500 ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5501 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5502 {
5503 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5504 asection *s;
5505 bfd_boolean relocs;
5506 bfd *ibfd;
5507
5508 #ifdef DEBUG
5509 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5510 #endif
5511
5512 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5513 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5514
5515 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5516 {
5517 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5518 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5519 {
5520 s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5521 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5522 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5523 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5524 }
5525 }
5526
5527 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5528 htab->got_header_size = 16;
5529 else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5530 htab->got_header_size = 12;
5531
5532 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5533 relocs. */
5534 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5535 {
5536 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5537 bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5538 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5539 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5540 char *lgot_masks;
5541 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5542 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5543
5544 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5545 continue;
5546
5547 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5548 {
5549 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5550
5551 for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5552 elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5553 p != NULL;
5554 p = p->next)
5555 {
5556 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5557 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5558 {
5559 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5560 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5561 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5562 the relocs too. */
5563 }
5564 else if (htab->is_vxworks
5565 && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5566 ".tls_vars") == 0)
5567 {
5568 /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5569 handled specially by the loader. */
5570 }
5571 else if (p->count != 0)
5572 {
5573 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5574 if (p->ifunc)
5575 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5576 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5577 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5578 & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5579 == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5580 {
5581 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5582 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5583 p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5584 }
5585 }
5586 }
5587 }
5588
5589 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5590 if (!local_got)
5591 continue;
5592
5593 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5594 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5595 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5596 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5597 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5598 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5599
5600 for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5601 if (*local_got > 0)
5602 {
5603 unsigned int need;
5604 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5605 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5606 need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5607 if (need == 0)
5608 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5609 else
5610 {
5611 *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5612 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5613 {
5614 asection *srel;
5615 bfd_boolean tprel_known = bfd_link_executable (info);
5616
5617 need = got_relocs_needed (*lgot_masks, need, tprel_known);
5618 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5619 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5620 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5621 srel->size += need;
5622 }
5623 }
5624 }
5625 else
5626 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5627
5628 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5629 continue;
5630
5631 /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5632 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5633 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5634 {
5635 struct plt_entry *ent;
5636 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5637 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5638
5639 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5640 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5641 {
5642 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5643 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5644 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5645 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5646 {
5647 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5648 continue;
5649 }
5650 else
5651 s = htab->pltlocal;
5652
5653 if (!doneone)
5654 {
5655 plt_offset = s->size;
5656 s->size += 4;
5657 }
5658 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5659
5660 if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5661 {
5662 s = htab->glink;
5663 glink_offset = s->size;
5664 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5665 }
5666 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5667
5668 if (!doneone)
5669 {
5670 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5671 {
5672 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5673 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5674 }
5675 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5676 {
5677 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5678 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5679 }
5680 doneone = TRUE;
5681 }
5682 }
5683 else
5684 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5685 }
5686 }
5687
5688 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5689 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5690
5691 if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5692 {
5693 htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5694 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5695 htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5696 }
5697 else
5698 htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5699
5700 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5701 {
5702 unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5703
5704 /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5705 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5706 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5707 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5708 if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5709 {
5710 g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5711 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5712 g_o_t += 4;
5713 htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5714 }
5715
5716 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5717 }
5718 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5719 {
5720 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5721
5722 sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5723 sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5724 }
5725 if (info->emitrelocations)
5726 {
5727 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5728
5729 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5730 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5731 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5732 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5733 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5734 }
5735
5736 if (htab->glink != NULL
5737 && htab->glink->size != 0
5738 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5739 {
5740 htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5741 /* Space for the branch table. */
5742 htab->glink->size
5743 += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5744 /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5745 htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5746 ? 63 : 15);
5747 htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5748
5749 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5750 {
5751 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5752 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5753 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5754 if (sh == NULL)
5755 return FALSE;
5756 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5757 {
5758 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5759 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5760 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5761 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5762 sh->def_regular = 1;
5763 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5764 sh->forced_local = 1;
5765 sh->non_elf = 0;
5766 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5767 }
5768 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5769 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5770 if (sh == NULL)
5771 return FALSE;
5772 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5773 {
5774 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5775 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5776 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5777 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5778 sh->def_regular = 1;
5779 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5780 sh->forced_local = 1;
5781 sh->non_elf = 0;
5782 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5783 }
5784 }
5785 }
5786
5787 if (htab->glink != NULL
5788 && htab->glink->size != 0
5789 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5790 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5791 && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5792 {
5793 s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5794 s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5795 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5796 {
5797 s->size += 4;
5798 if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5799 s->size += 4;
5800 }
5801 }
5802
5803 /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5804 Allocate memory for them. */
5805 relocs = FALSE;
5806 for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5807 {
5808 bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5809
5810 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5811 continue;
5812
5813 if (s == htab->elf.splt
5814 || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5815 {
5816 /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5817 we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5818 It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5819 if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5820 strip_section = FALSE;
5821 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5822 comment below. */
5823 }
5824 else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5825 || s == htab->pltlocal
5826 || s == htab->glink
5827 || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5828 || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5829 || s == htab->sbss
5830 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5831 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5832 || s == htab->dynsbss)
5833 {
5834 /* Strip these too. */
5835 }
5836 else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5837 || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5838 {
5839 strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5840 }
5841 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_get_section_name (htab->elf.dynobj, s),
5842 ".rela"))
5843 {
5844 if (s->size != 0)
5845 {
5846 /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5847 relocs = TRUE;
5848
5849 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5850 to copy relocs into the output file. */
5851 s->reloc_count = 0;
5852 }
5853 }
5854 else
5855 {
5856 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5857 continue;
5858 }
5859
5860 if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5861 {
5862 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5863 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5864 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5865 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5866 before the linker maps input sections to output
5867 sections. The linker does that before
5868 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5869 function which decides whether anything needs to go
5870 into these sections. */
5871 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5872 continue;
5873 }
5874
5875 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5876 continue;
5877
5878 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5879 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5880 if (s->contents == NULL)
5881 return FALSE;
5882 }
5883
5884 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5885 {
5886 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5887 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5888 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5889 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5890 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5891 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5892 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5893
5894 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
5895 {
5896 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
5897 return FALSE;
5898 }
5899
5900 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
5901 {
5902 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
5903 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
5904 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
5905 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
5906 return FALSE;
5907 }
5908
5909 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5910 && htab->glink != NULL
5911 && htab->glink->size != 0)
5912 {
5913 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5914 return FALSE;
5915 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5916 && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5917 && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5918 && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5919 return FALSE;
5920 }
5921
5922 if (relocs)
5923 {
5924 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
5925 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
5926 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
5927 return FALSE;
5928 }
5929
5930 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section, then we
5931 need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
5932 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
5933 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), maybe_set_textrel,
5934 info);
5935
5936 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
5937 {
5938 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
5939 return FALSE;
5940 }
5941 if (htab->is_vxworks
5942 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
5943 return FALSE;
5944 }
5945 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5946
5947 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5948 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5949 {
5950 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5951 bfd_vma val;
5952
5953 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5954 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5955 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5956 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5957 /* FDE length. */
5958 val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5959 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5960 p += 4;
5961 /* CIE pointer. */
5962 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5963 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5964 p += 4;
5965 /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5966 p += 4;
5967 /* .glink size. */
5968 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5969 p += 4;
5970 /* Augmentation. */
5971 p += 1;
5972
5973 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5974 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5975 {
5976 bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5977 if (adv < 64)
5978 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5979 else if (adv < 256)
5980 {
5981 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5982 *p++ = adv;
5983 }
5984 else if (adv < 65536)
5985 {
5986 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5987 bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5988 p += 2;
5989 }
5990 else
5991 {
5992 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5993 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5994 p += 4;
5995 }
5996 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5997 *p++ = 65;
5998 p++;
5999 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
6000 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
6001 *p++ = 65;
6002 }
6003 BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
6004 == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
6005 }
6006
6007 return TRUE;
6008 }
6009
6010 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
6011 if it looks like nothing is using them. */
6012
6013 static void
6014 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
6015 {
6016 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
6017
6018 if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
6019 {
6020 asection *s;
6021
6022 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
6023 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6024 {
6025 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
6026 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6027 {
6028 sda->def_regular = 0;
6029 /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
6030 sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
6031 sda->forced_local = 0;
6032 }
6033 }
6034 }
6035 }
6036
6037 void
6038 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6039 {
6040 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6041
6042 if (htab != NULL)
6043 {
6044 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6045 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6046 }
6047 }
6048
6049
6050 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6051
6052 static bfd_boolean
6053 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6054 {
6055 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6056 && !h->def_regular
6057 && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6058 || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6059 return FALSE;
6060
6061 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6062 }
6063 \f
6064 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6065
6066 /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6067 used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6068 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6069 {
6070 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6071 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6072 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6073 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6074 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6075 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6076 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6077 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6078 };
6079
6080 static const int stub_entry[] =
6081 {
6082 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6083 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6084 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6085 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6086 };
6087
6088 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6089 {
6090 unsigned int workaround_size;
6091 unsigned int picfixup_size;
6092 };
6093
6094 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6095 icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6096 space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6097 add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6098
6099 static bfd_boolean
6100 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6101 asection *isec,
6102 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6103 bfd_boolean *again)
6104 {
6105 struct one_branch_fixup
6106 {
6107 struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6108 asection *tsec;
6109 /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6110 relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6111 bfd_vma toff;
6112 bfd_vma trampoff;
6113 };
6114
6115 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6116 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6117 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6118 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6119 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6120 struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6121 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6122 unsigned changes = 0;
6123 bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6124 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6125 bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6126 asection *got2;
6127 bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6128
6129 *again = FALSE;
6130
6131 /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6132 if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6133 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6134 || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6135 || isec->size < 4)
6136 return TRUE;
6137
6138 /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6139 do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6140 anyway. */
6141 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6142 return TRUE;
6143
6144 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6145 if (htab == NULL)
6146 return TRUE;
6147
6148 isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6149 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6150 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6151 trampbase = isec->size;
6152
6153 BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6154 || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6155 isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6156
6157 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6158 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6159 {
6160 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6161 {
6162 elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6163 = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6164 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6165 return FALSE;
6166 }
6167 relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6168 trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6169 }
6170
6171 maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6172 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6173 /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6174 trampoff = trampbase;
6175 if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6176 trampoff += 4;
6177
6178 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6179 picfixup_size = 0;
6180 if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6181 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6182 {
6183 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6184 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6185 {
6186 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6187 link_info->keep_memory);
6188 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6189 goto error_return;
6190 }
6191
6192 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6193
6194 irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6195 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6196 {
6197 unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6198 bfd_vma toff, roff;
6199 asection *tsec;
6200 struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6201 size_t insn_offset = 0;
6202 bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6203 bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6204 unsigned long t0;
6205 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6206 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6207 struct plt_entry **plist;
6208 unsigned char sym_type;
6209
6210 switch (r_type)
6211 {
6212 case R_PPC_REL24:
6213 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6214 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6215 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6216 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6217 break;
6218
6219 case R_PPC_REL14:
6220 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6221 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6222 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6223 break;
6224
6225 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6226 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6227 break;
6228 continue;
6229
6230 default:
6231 continue;
6232 }
6233
6234 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6235 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6236 ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6237 goto error_return;
6238
6239 if (isym != NULL)
6240 {
6241 if (tsec != NULL)
6242 ;
6243 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6244 tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6245 else
6246 continue;
6247
6248 toff = isym->st_value;
6249 sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6250 }
6251 else
6252 {
6253 if (tsec != NULL)
6254 toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6255 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6256 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6257 {
6258 unsigned long indx;
6259
6260 indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6261 tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6262 toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6263 }
6264 else
6265 continue;
6266
6267 /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6268 optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6269 branch stub in that case. */
6270 if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6271 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6272 && irel != internal_relocs)
6273 {
6274 unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6275 unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6276 unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6277
6278 /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6279 R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6280 on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6281 mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6282 if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6283 {
6284 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6285
6286 if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6287 {
6288 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6289 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6290 char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6291 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6292 tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6293 }
6294 }
6295 else
6296 {
6297 struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6298 = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6299
6300 while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6301 || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6302 th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6303
6304 tls_mask
6305 = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6306 }
6307
6308 /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6309 optimised away. */
6310 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6311 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6312 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6313 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6314 continue;
6315 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6316 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6317 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6318 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6319 continue;
6320 }
6321
6322 sym_type = h->type;
6323 }
6324
6325 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6326 {
6327 if (h != NULL
6328 && !h->def_regular
6329 && h->protected_def
6330 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6331 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6332 picfixup_size += 12;
6333 continue;
6334 }
6335
6336 /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6337 match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6338 but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6339 destination used here may be incorrect. */
6340 plist = NULL;
6341 if (h != NULL)
6342 {
6343 /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6344 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6345 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6346 plist = &h->plt.plist;
6347 }
6348 else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6349 && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6350 {
6351 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6352 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6353 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6354 plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6355 }
6356 if (plist != NULL)
6357 {
6358 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6359 struct plt_entry *ent;
6360
6361 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6362 addend = irel->r_addend;
6363 ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6364 if (ent != NULL)
6365 {
6366 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6367 || h == NULL
6368 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6369 || h->dynindx == -1)
6370 {
6371 tsec = htab->glink;
6372 toff = ent->glink_offset;
6373 }
6374 else
6375 {
6376 tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6377 toff = ent->plt.offset;
6378 }
6379 }
6380 }
6381
6382 /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6383 no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6384 branch overflow. */
6385 if (tsec == isec)
6386 continue;
6387
6388 /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6389 undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6390 support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6391 putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6392 branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6393 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6394 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6395 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6396 && irel->r_addend != 0)
6397 continue;
6398
6399 /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6400 SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6401 attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6402 branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6403 reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6404 if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6405 {
6406 /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6407 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6408 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6409 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6410 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6411
6412 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6413 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6414 the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6415 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6416 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6417 location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6418 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6419 a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6420 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6421 location of interest is just "sym". */
6422 if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6423 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6424 toff += irel->r_addend;
6425
6426 toff
6427 = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6428 elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6429 toff);
6430
6431 if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6432 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6433 toff += irel->r_addend;
6434 }
6435 /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6436 else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6437 toff += irel->r_addend;
6438
6439 /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6440 if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6441 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6442 || tsec->output_section == NULL
6443 || (tsec->owner != NULL
6444 && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6445 continue;
6446
6447 roff = irel->r_offset;
6448
6449 /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6450 relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6451 fixup can be created at final link.
6452 The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6453 of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6454 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6455 && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6456 < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6457 continue;
6458
6459 /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6460 if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6461 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6462 /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6463 final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6464 || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6465 {
6466 bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6467
6468 symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6469 reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6470 if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6471 < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6472 continue;
6473 }
6474
6475 /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6476 for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6477 if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6478 break;
6479
6480 if (f == NULL)
6481 {
6482 size_t size;
6483 unsigned long stub_rtype;
6484
6485 val = trampoff - roff;
6486 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6487 /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6488 one. We'll report an error later. */
6489 continue;
6490
6491 if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6492 {
6493 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6494 insn_offset = 12;
6495 }
6496 else
6497 {
6498 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6499 insn_offset = 0;
6500 }
6501 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6502 if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6503 || tsec == htab->glink)
6504 {
6505 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6506 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6507 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6508 }
6509
6510 /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6511 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6512 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6513 stub_rtype);
6514 irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6515 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6516 && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6517 irel->r_addend = 0;
6518
6519 /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6520 f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6521 f->next = branch_fixups;
6522 f->tsec = tsec;
6523 f->toff = toff;
6524 f->trampoff = trampoff;
6525 branch_fixups = f;
6526
6527 trampoff += size;
6528 changes++;
6529 }
6530 else
6531 {
6532 val = f->trampoff - roff;
6533 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6534 continue;
6535
6536 /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6537 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6538 }
6539
6540 /* Get the section contents. */
6541 if (contents == NULL)
6542 {
6543 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6544 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6545 contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6546 /* Go get them off disk. */
6547 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6548 goto error_return;
6549 }
6550
6551 /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6552 hit_addr = contents + roff;
6553 switch (r_type)
6554 {
6555 case R_PPC_REL24:
6556 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6557 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6558 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6559 t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6560 t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6561 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6562 break;
6563
6564 case R_PPC_REL14:
6565 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6566 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6567 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6568 t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6569 t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6570 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6571 break;
6572 }
6573 }
6574
6575 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6576 {
6577 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6578 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6579 free (f);
6580 }
6581 }
6582
6583 workaround_change = FALSE;
6584 newsize = trampoff;
6585 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6586 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6587 || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6588 {
6589 bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6590 unsigned int crossings;
6591 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6592
6593 addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6594 end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6595 addr &= -pagesize;
6596 crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6597 if (crossings != 0)
6598 {
6599 /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6600 not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6601 previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6602 newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6603 newsize += crossings * 16;
6604 if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6605 {
6606 relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6607 workaround_change = TRUE;
6608 }
6609 /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6610 isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6611 }
6612 newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6613 }
6614
6615 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6616 {
6617 picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6618 if (picfixup_size != 0)
6619 relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6620 newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6621 }
6622
6623 if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6624 isec->size = newsize;
6625
6626 if (isymbuf != NULL
6627 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6628 {
6629 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6630 free (isymbuf);
6631 else
6632 {
6633 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6634 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6635 }
6636 }
6637
6638 if (contents != NULL
6639 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6640 {
6641 if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6642 free (contents);
6643 else
6644 {
6645 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6646 elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6647 }
6648 }
6649
6650 changes += picfixup_size;
6651 if (changes != 0)
6652 {
6653 /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6654 information for the trampolines. */
6655 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6656 Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6657 * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6658 unsigned ix;
6659
6660 if (!new_relocs)
6661 goto error_return;
6662 memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6663 isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6664 for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6665 {
6666 irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6667
6668 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6669 }
6670 if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6671 free (internal_relocs);
6672 elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6673 isec->reloc_count += changes;
6674 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6675 rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6676 }
6677 else if (internal_relocs != NULL
6678 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6679 free (internal_relocs);
6680
6681 *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6682 return TRUE;
6683
6684 error_return:
6685 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6686 {
6687 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6688 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6689 free (f);
6690 }
6691 if (isymbuf != NULL && (unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6692 free (isymbuf);
6693 if (contents != NULL
6694 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6695 free (contents);
6696 if (internal_relocs != NULL
6697 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6698 free (internal_relocs);
6699 return FALSE;
6700 }
6701 \f
6702 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6703 discarded sections. */
6704
6705 static unsigned int
6706 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6707 {
6708 if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6709 return 0;
6710
6711 if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6712 return 0;
6713
6714 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6715 }
6716 \f
6717 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6718
6719 static bfd_vma
6720 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6721 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6722 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6723 bfd_vma relocation,
6724 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6725 {
6726 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6727
6728 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6729
6730 if (h != NULL)
6731 {
6732 /* Handle global symbol. */
6733 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6734
6735 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6736 BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6737 linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6738 }
6739 else
6740 {
6741 /* Handle local symbol. */
6742 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6743
6744 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6745 BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6746 linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6747 }
6748
6749 linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6750 rel->r_addend,
6751 lsect);
6752 BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6753
6754 /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6755 as a "written" flag. */
6756 if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6757 {
6758 bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6759 relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6760 lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6761 linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6762 }
6763
6764 relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6765 + lsect->section->output_offset
6766 + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6767 - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6768
6769 #ifdef DEBUG
6770 fprintf (stderr,
6771 "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6772 lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6773 #endif
6774
6775 return relocation;
6776 }
6777
6778 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6779 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6780 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6781
6782 static void
6783 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6784 asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6785 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6786 {
6787 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6788 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6789 bfd_vma plt;
6790 unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6791
6792 if (h != NULL
6793 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6794 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6795 {
6796 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6797 p += 4;
6798 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6799 p += 4;
6800 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6801 p += 4;
6802 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6803 p += 4;
6804 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6805 p += 4;
6806 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6807 p += 4;
6808 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6809 p += 4;
6810 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6811 p += 4;
6812 }
6813
6814 plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6815 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6816 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6817
6818 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6819 {
6820 bfd_vma got = 0;
6821
6822 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6823 got = (ent->addend
6824 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6825 + ent->sec->output_offset);
6826 else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6827 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6828
6829 plt -= got;
6830
6831 if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6832 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6833 else
6834 {
6835 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6836 p += 4;
6837 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6838 }
6839 }
6840 else
6841 {
6842 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6843 p += 4;
6844 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6845 }
6846 p += 4;
6847 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6848 p += 4;
6849 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6850 p += 4;
6851 while (p < end)
6852 {
6853 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6854 p += 4;
6855 }
6856 }
6857
6858 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6859
6860 static bfd_boolean
6861 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6862 {
6863 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6864 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6865 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6866 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6867 }
6868
6869 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6870 the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6871 REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6872
6873 unsigned int
6874 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6875 {
6876 unsigned int rtra;
6877
6878 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6879 return 0;
6880
6881 if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6882 rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6883 else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6884 rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6885 else
6886 return 0;
6887
6888 if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6889 /* add -> addi. */
6890 insn = 14 << 26;
6891 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6892 && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6893 || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6894 && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6895 /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6896 insn = (32 | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6897 else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6898 /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6899 insn = ((58 | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6900 else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6901 /* lwax -> lwa. */
6902 insn = (58 << 26) | 2;
6903 else
6904 return 0;
6905 insn |= rtra;
6906 return insn;
6907 }
6908
6909 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6910 the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6911 thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6912
6913 unsigned int
6914 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6915 {
6916 if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6917 && ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6918 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6919 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6920 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6921 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6922 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6923 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6924 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6925 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6926 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6927 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6928 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6929 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6930 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6931 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6932 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6933 && (insn & 3) != 1)
6934 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6935 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6936 {
6937 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6938 }
6939 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6940 && ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6941 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6942 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6943 {
6944 insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6945 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6946 if ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26 << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6947 insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6948 }
6949 else
6950 insn = 0;
6951 return insn;
6952 }
6953
6954 static bfd_boolean
6955 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6956 {
6957 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6958 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6959 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6960 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6961 }
6962
6963 static bfd_boolean
6964 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6965 {
6966 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6967 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6968 && (insn & 3) == 1));
6969 }
6970
6971 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6972 to handle the relocations for a section.
6973
6974 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6975 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6976 zero.
6977
6978 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6979 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6980 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6981 necessary.
6982
6983 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6984 address or the reloc symbol index.
6985
6986 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6987
6988 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6989 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6990
6991 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6992 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6993
6994 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6995 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
6996 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6997 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6998 accordingly. */
6999
7000 static bfd_boolean
7001 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
7002 struct bfd_link_info *info,
7003 bfd *input_bfd,
7004 asection *input_section,
7005 bfd_byte *contents,
7006 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7007 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7008 asection **local_sections)
7009 {
7010 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7011 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
7012 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7013 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7014 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
7015 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
7016 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
7017 asection *got2;
7018 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
7019 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
7020 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
7021 bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
7022 unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
7023 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
7024
7025 #ifdef DEBUG
7026 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
7027 "%ld relocations%s",
7028 input_bfd, input_section,
7029 (long) input_section->reloc_count,
7030 (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
7031 #endif
7032
7033 if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
7034 {
7035 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7036 return FALSE;
7037 }
7038
7039 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7040
7041 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7042 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7043 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7044
7045 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7046 local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7047 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7048 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7049 /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7050 specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7051 is_vxworks_tls = (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7052 && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7053 ".tls_vars"));
7054 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7055 relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7056 rel = wrel = relocs;
7057 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7058 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7059 {
7060 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7061 bfd_vma addend;
7062 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7063 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7064 asection *sec;
7065 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7066 const char *sym_name;
7067 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7068 unsigned long r_symndx;
7069 bfd_vma relocation;
7070 bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7071 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7072 bfd_boolean warned;
7073 unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7074 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7075 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7076
7077 again:
7078 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7079 sym = NULL;
7080 sec = NULL;
7081 h = NULL;
7082 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7083 warned = FALSE;
7084 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7085
7086 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7087 {
7088 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7089 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7090 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7091
7092 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7093 }
7094 else
7095 {
7096 bfd_boolean ignored;
7097
7098 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7099 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7100 h, sec, relocation,
7101 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7102
7103 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7104 }
7105
7106 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7107 {
7108 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7109 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7110 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7111 howto = NULL;
7112 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7113 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7114
7115 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7116 contents, rel->r_offset);
7117 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7118 wrel->r_info = 0;
7119 wrel->r_addend = 0;
7120
7121 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7122 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7123 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7124 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7125 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7126 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7127 wrel--;
7128
7129 continue;
7130 }
7131
7132 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7133 {
7134 if (got2 != NULL
7135 && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7136 && rel->r_addend != 0)
7137 {
7138 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7139 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7140 rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7141 }
7142 if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7143 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7144 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7145 goto copy_reloc;
7146 }
7147
7148 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7149 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7150 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7151 for the final instruction stream. */
7152 tls_mask = 0;
7153 tls_gd = 0;
7154 if (h != NULL)
7155 tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7156 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7157 {
7158 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7159 char *lgot_masks;
7160 local_plt
7161 = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7162 lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7163 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7164 }
7165
7166 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7167 if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7168 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7169 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7170 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7171 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7172 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7173 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7174 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7175 abort ();
7176 switch (r_type)
7177 {
7178 default:
7179 break;
7180
7181 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7182 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7183 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7184 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7185 {
7186 bfd_vma insn;
7187
7188 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7189 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7190 insn &= 31 << 21;
7191 insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7192 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7193 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7194 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7195 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7196 }
7197 break;
7198
7199 case R_PPC_TLS:
7200 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7201 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7202 {
7203 bfd_vma insn;
7204
7205 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7206 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7207 if (insn == 0)
7208 abort ();
7209 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7210 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7211 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7212
7213 /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7214 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7215 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7216 }
7217 break;
7218
7219 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7220 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7221 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7222 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7223 goto tls_gdld_hi;
7224 break;
7225
7226 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7227 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7228 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7229 {
7230 tls_gdld_hi:
7231 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7232 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7233 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7234 else
7235 {
7236 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7237 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7238 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7239 }
7240 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7241 }
7242 break;
7243
7244 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7245 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7246 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7247 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7248 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7249 break;
7250
7251 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7252 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7253 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7254 {
7255 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7256 bfd_vma offset;
7257
7258 tls_ldgd_opt:
7259 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7260 /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7261 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7262 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7263 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7264 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7265 if (input_section->has_tls_get_addr_call
7266 && rel + 1 < relend
7267 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7268 htab->tls_get_addr))
7269 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7270 /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7271 the destination reg. It may be something other than
7272 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7273 intervening code. */
7274 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7275 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7276 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7277 {
7278 /* IE */
7279 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7280 insn1 |= 32 << 26; /* lwz */
7281 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7282 {
7283 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7284 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7285 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7286 }
7287 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7288 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7289 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7290 }
7291 else
7292 {
7293 /* LE */
7294 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7295 insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7296 if (tls_gd == 0)
7297 {
7298 /* Was an LD reloc. */
7299 for (r_symndx = 0;
7300 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7301 r_symndx++)
7302 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7303 break;
7304 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7305 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7306 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7307 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7308 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7309 + sec->output_offset
7310 + sec->output_section->vma);
7311 }
7312 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7313 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7314 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7315 {
7316 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7317 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7318 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7319 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7320 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7321 }
7322 }
7323 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7324 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7325 if (tls_gd == 0)
7326 {
7327 /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7328 in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7329 goto again;
7330 }
7331 }
7332 break;
7333
7334 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7335 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7336 && rel + 1 < relend)
7337 {
7338 unsigned int insn2;
7339 bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7340
7341 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7342 {
7343 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7344 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7345 break;
7346 }
7347
7348 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7349 {
7350 /* IE */
7351 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7352 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7353 }
7354 else
7355 {
7356 /* LE */
7357 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7358 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7359 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7360 }
7361 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7362 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7363 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7364 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7365 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7366 }
7367 break;
7368
7369 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7370 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7371 && rel + 1 < relend)
7372 {
7373 unsigned int insn2;
7374
7375 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7376 {
7377 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7378 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7379 break;
7380 }
7381
7382 for (r_symndx = 0;
7383 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7384 r_symndx++)
7385 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7386 break;
7387 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7388 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7389 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7390 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7391 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7392 + sec->output_offset
7393 + sec->output_section->vma);
7394
7395 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7396 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7397 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7398 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7399 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7400 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7401 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7402 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7403 goto again;
7404 }
7405 break;
7406 }
7407
7408 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7409 branch_bit = 0;
7410 switch (r_type)
7411 {
7412 default:
7413 break;
7414
7415 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7416 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7417 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7418 branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7419 /* Fall through. */
7420
7421 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7422 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7423 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7424 {
7425 unsigned int insn;
7426
7427 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7428 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7429 insn |= branch_bit;
7430
7431 from = (rel->r_offset
7432 + input_section->output_offset
7433 + input_section->output_section->vma);
7434
7435 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7436 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7437 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7438
7439 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7440 }
7441 break;
7442
7443 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7444 {
7445 unsigned int insn;
7446
7447 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7448 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7449 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26
7450 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7451 {
7452 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7453 {
7454 /* Convert addis to lis. */
7455 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7456 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7457 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7458 }
7459 }
7460 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7461 info->callbacks->einfo
7462 (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7463 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7464 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7465 }
7466 break;
7467 }
7468
7469 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7470 && h != NULL
7471 && !h->def_regular
7472 && h->protected_def
7473 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7474 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7475 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7476 {
7477 /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7478 variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7479 unsigned int insn;
7480
7481 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7482 {
7483 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7484 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7485 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7486 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7487 {
7488 bfd_byte *p;
7489 bfd_vma off;
7490 bfd_vma got_addr;
7491
7492 p = (contents + input_section->size
7493 - relax_info->workaround_size
7494 - relax_info->picfixup_size
7495 + picfixup_size);
7496 off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7497 if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7498 info->callbacks->einfo
7499 (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7500 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7501
7502 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7503 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7504 got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7505 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7506 + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7507 wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7508 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7509 wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7510 insn &= ~0xffff;
7511 insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7512 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7513
7514 /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7515 insn &= ~0xffff;
7516 insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7517 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7518 insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7519 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7520
7521 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7522 picfixup_size += 12;
7523
7524 /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7525 output is reasonable. */
7526 memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7527 wrel++, rel++;
7528 rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7529 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7530 rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7531
7532 /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7533 dynamic reloc. */
7534 r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7535 }
7536 else
7537 _bfd_error_handler
7538 /* xgettext:c-format */
7539 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7540 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7541 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7542 "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7543 }
7544 else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7545 {
7546 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7547 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7548 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7549 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7550 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7551 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7552 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7553 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7554 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7555 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7556 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7557 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7558 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7559 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7560 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7561 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7562 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7563 && (insn & 3) != 1)
7564 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7565 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7566 {
7567 /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7568 relocation = 0;
7569 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7570 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7571 }
7572 else
7573 _bfd_error_handler
7574 /* xgettext:c-format */
7575 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7576 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7577 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7578 "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7579 }
7580 }
7581
7582 ifunc = NULL;
7583 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7584 {
7585 struct plt_entry *ent;
7586
7587 if (h != NULL)
7588 {
7589 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7590 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7591 }
7592 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7593 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7594 {
7595 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7596
7597 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7598 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7599 ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7600 }
7601
7602 ent = NULL;
7603 if (ifunc != NULL
7604 && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7605 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7606 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7607 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7608 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7609 {
7610 addend = 0;
7611 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7612 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7613 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7614 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7615 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7616 addend = rel->r_addend;
7617 ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7618 }
7619 if (ent != NULL)
7620 {
7621 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7622 && ent->sec != got2
7623 && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7624 && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7625 || h == NULL
7626 || h->dynindx == -1))
7627 {
7628 /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7629 for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7630 finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7631 apparently are using code compiled with
7632 -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7633 gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7634 whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7635 is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7636 into .got2). */
7637 info->callbacks->einfo
7638 /* xgettext:c-format */
7639 (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7640 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7641 }
7642
7643 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7644 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7645 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7646 || h == NULL
7647 || h->dynindx == -1)
7648 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7649 + htab->glink->output_offset
7650 + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7651 else
7652 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7653 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7654 + ent->plt.offset);
7655 }
7656 }
7657
7658 addend = rel->r_addend;
7659 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7660 howto = NULL;
7661 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7662 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7663
7664 switch (r_type)
7665 {
7666 default:
7667 break;
7668
7669 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7670 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7671 {
7672 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7673 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7674 if ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
7675 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
7676 /* xgettext:c-format */
7677 info->callbacks->minfo
7678 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
7679 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
7680 else
7681 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
7682 }
7683 break;
7684
7685 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7686 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7687 {
7688 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7689 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7690 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7691 insn |= 2 << 16;
7692 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7693 }
7694 break;
7695 }
7696
7697 tls_type = 0;
7698 switch (r_type)
7699 {
7700 default:
7701 /* xgettext:c-format */
7702 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7703 input_bfd, howto->name);
7704
7705 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7706 ret = FALSE;
7707 goto copy_reloc;
7708
7709 case R_PPC_NONE:
7710 case R_PPC_TLS:
7711 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7712 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7713 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7714 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7715 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7716 goto copy_reloc;
7717
7718 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7719 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7720 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7721 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7722 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7723 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7724 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7725 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7726 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7727 goto dogot;
7728
7729 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7730 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7731 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7732 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7733 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7734 goto dogot;
7735
7736 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7737 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7738 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7739 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7740 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7741 goto dogot;
7742
7743 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7744 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7745 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7746 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7747 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7748 goto dogot;
7749
7750 case R_PPC_GOT16:
7751 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7752 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7753 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7754 tls_mask = 0;
7755 dogot:
7756 {
7757 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7758 offset table. */
7759 bfd_vma off;
7760 bfd_vma *offp;
7761 unsigned long indx;
7762
7763 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7764 abort ();
7765
7766 indx = 0;
7767 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7768 && (h == NULL
7769 || !h->def_dynamic))
7770 offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7771 else if (h != NULL)
7772 {
7773 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7774 || h->dynindx == -1
7775 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7776 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7777 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7778 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7779 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7780 because of a version file. */
7781 ;
7782 else
7783 {
7784 indx = h->dynindx;
7785 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7786 }
7787 offp = &h->got.offset;
7788 }
7789 else
7790 {
7791 if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7792 abort ();
7793 offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7794 }
7795
7796 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7797 least significant bit to record whether we have already
7798 processed this entry. */
7799 off = *offp;
7800 if ((off & 1) != 0)
7801 off &= ~1;
7802 else
7803 {
7804 unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7805 ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7806 | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7807 : 0);
7808
7809 if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7810 tls_m = TLS_LD;
7811 else if (h == NULL
7812 || !h->def_dynamic)
7813 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7814
7815 /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7816 Initialize them all. */
7817 do
7818 {
7819 int tls_ty = 0;
7820
7821 if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7822 {
7823 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7824 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7825 }
7826 else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7827 {
7828 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7829 tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7830 }
7831 else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7832 {
7833 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7834 tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7835 }
7836 else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7837 {
7838 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7839 tls_m = 0;
7840 }
7841
7842 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7843 if (indx != 0
7844 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7845 && (h == NULL
7846 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)
7847 || offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7848 && !(tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL)
7849 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7850 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7851 {
7852 asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7853 bfd_byte * loc;
7854
7855 if (ifunc != NULL)
7856 {
7857 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7858 if (indx == 0)
7859 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7860 else if (is_static_defined (h))
7861 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7862 }
7863 outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7864 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7865 + off);
7866 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7867 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7868 {
7869 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7870 if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7871 {
7872 loc = rsec->contents;
7873 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7874 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7875 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7876 &outrel, loc);
7877 outrel.r_offset += 4;
7878 outrel.r_info
7879 = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7880 }
7881 }
7882 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7883 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7884 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7885 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7886 else if (indx != 0)
7887 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7888 else if (ifunc != NULL)
7889 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7890 else
7891 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7892 if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7893 {
7894 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7895 if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7896 {
7897 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7898 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7899 else
7900 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7901 }
7902 }
7903 loc = rsec->contents;
7904 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7905 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7906 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7907 }
7908
7909 /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7910 emitting a reloc. */
7911 else
7912 {
7913 bfd_vma value = relocation;
7914
7915 if (tls_ty != 0)
7916 {
7917 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7918 value = 0;
7919 else
7920 {
7921 if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7922 value = 0;
7923 else
7924 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7925 if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7926 value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7927 }
7928
7929 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7930 {
7931 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7932 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7933 value = 1;
7934 }
7935 }
7936 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7937 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7938 }
7939
7940 off += 4;
7941 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7942 off += 4;
7943 }
7944 while (tls_m != 0);
7945
7946 off = *offp;
7947 *offp = off | 1;
7948 }
7949
7950 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7951 abort ();
7952
7953 if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7954 {
7955 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7956 {
7957 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7958 && !(h == NULL
7959 || !h->def_dynamic))
7960 off += 8;
7961 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7962 {
7963 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7964 off += 8;
7965 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7966 {
7967 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7968 off += 4;
7969 }
7970 }
7971 }
7972 }
7973
7974 /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7975 if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7976 goto copy_reloc;
7977
7978 relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7979 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7980 + off
7981 - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7982
7983 /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7984 x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7985 generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7986 got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7987 if (addend != 0)
7988 info->callbacks->einfo
7989 /* xgettext:c-format */
7990 (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7991 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7992 howto->name,
7993 sym_name);
7994 }
7995 break;
7996
7997 /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7998 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7999 /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
8000 at a symbol not in this object. */
8001 if (unresolved_reloc)
8002 {
8003 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
8004 h->root.root.string,
8005 input_bfd,
8006 input_section,
8007 rel->r_offset,
8008 TRUE);
8009 goto copy_reloc;
8010 }
8011 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
8012 {
8013 /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
8014 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
8015 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
8016 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
8017 access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
8018 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
8019 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
8020 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
8021 /* xgettext:c-format */
8022 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
8023 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8024 h->root.root.string);
8025 }
8026 break;
8027
8028 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8029 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8030 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
8031 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8032 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8033 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8034 break;
8035
8036 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
8037 object. */
8038 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8039 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8040 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8041 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8042 if (h != NULL
8043 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8044 && h->dynindx == -1)
8045 {
8046 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8047 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8048 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8049 defined before using them. */
8050 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8051 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8052 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8053 if (insn != 0)
8054 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8055 break;
8056 }
8057 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8058 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8059 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8060 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8061 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8062 goto dodyn;
8063
8064 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8065 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8066 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8067 goto dodyn;
8068
8069 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8070 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8071 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8072 goto dodyn;
8073
8074 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8075 relocation = 1;
8076 addend = 0;
8077 goto dodyn;
8078
8079 case R_PPC_REL16:
8080 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8081 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8082 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8083 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8084 break;
8085
8086 case R_PPC_REL32:
8087 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8088 break;
8089 /* fall through */
8090
8091 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8092 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8093 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8094 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8095 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8096 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8097 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8098 goto dodyn;
8099
8100 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8101 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8102 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8103 case R_PPC_REL24:
8104 case R_PPC_REL14:
8105 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8106 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8107 /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8108 handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8109 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8110 || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8111 break;
8112 /* fall through */
8113
8114 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8115 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8116 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8117 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8118 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8119 break;
8120 /* fall through */
8121
8122 dodyn:
8123 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8124 || is_vxworks_tls)
8125 break;
8126
8127 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8128 ? ((h == NULL
8129 || ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8130 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8131 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8132 : (h != NULL
8133 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8134 {
8135 int skip;
8136 bfd_byte *loc;
8137 asection *sreloc;
8138 long indx = 0;
8139
8140 #ifdef DEBUG
8141 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8142 "create relocation for %s\n",
8143 (h && h->root.root.string
8144 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8145 #endif
8146
8147 /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8148 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8149 time. */
8150 skip = 0;
8151 outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8152 input_section,
8153 rel->r_offset);
8154 if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8155 || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8156 skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8157 outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8158 + input_section->output_offset);
8159
8160 if (skip)
8161 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8162 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8163 {
8164 indx = h->dynindx;
8165 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8166 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8167 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8168 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8169 }
8170 else
8171 {
8172 outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8173
8174 if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8175 {
8176 if (ifunc != NULL)
8177 {
8178 /* If we get here when building a static
8179 executable, then the libc startup function
8180 responsible for applying indirect function
8181 relocations is going to complain about
8182 the reloc type.
8183 If we get here when building a dynamic
8184 executable, it will be because we have
8185 a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8186 will set the text segment writable and
8187 non-executable to apply text relocations.
8188 So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8189 indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8190 info->callbacks->einfo
8191 /* xgettext:c-format */
8192 (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8193 "function %s unsupported\n"),
8194 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8195 howto->name,
8196 sym_name);
8197 ret = FALSE;
8198 }
8199 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8200 ;
8201 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8202 {
8203 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8204 ret = FALSE;
8205 }
8206 else
8207 {
8208 asection *osec;
8209
8210 /* We are turning this relocation into one
8211 against a section symbol. It would be
8212 proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8213 osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8214 but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8215 FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8216 osec = sec->output_section;
8217 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8218 {
8219 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8220 indx = 0;
8221 }
8222 else
8223 {
8224 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8225 if (indx == 0)
8226 {
8227 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8228 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8229 }
8230 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8231 }
8232
8233 /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8234 Don't leave the symbol value in the
8235 addend for them. */
8236 if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8237 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8238 }
8239
8240 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8241 }
8242 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8243 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8244 else
8245 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8246 }
8247
8248 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8249 if (ifunc)
8250 {
8251 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8252 if (indx == 0)
8253 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8254 else if (is_static_defined (h))
8255 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8256 }
8257 if (sreloc == NULL)
8258 return FALSE;
8259
8260 loc = sreloc->contents;
8261 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8262 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8263
8264 if (skip == -1)
8265 goto copy_reloc;
8266
8267 /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8268 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8269 if (!skip)
8270 {
8271 relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8272 addend = 0;
8273 break;
8274 }
8275 }
8276 break;
8277
8278 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8279 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8280 if (h != NULL)
8281 {
8282 struct plt_entry *ent;
8283 bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8284
8285 if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8286 {
8287 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8288 got2_addend = addend;
8289 addend = 0;
8290 }
8291 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8292 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8293 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8294 + htab->glink->output_offset
8295 + ent->glink_offset);
8296 else
8297 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8298 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8299 + ent->plt.offset);
8300 }
8301 /* Fall through. */
8302
8303 case R_PPC_RELAX:
8304 {
8305 const int *stub;
8306 size_t size;
8307 size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8308 unsigned int insn;
8309
8310 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8311 {
8312 relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8313 + input_section->output_offset
8314 + rel->r_offset - 4);
8315 stub = shared_stub_entry;
8316 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8317 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8318 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8319 stub += 3;
8320 size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8321 }
8322 else
8323 {
8324 stub = stub_entry;
8325 size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8326 }
8327
8328 relocation += addend;
8329 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8330 relocation = 0;
8331
8332 /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8333 insn = *stub++;
8334 insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8335 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8336 insn_offset += 4;
8337
8338 insn = *stub++;
8339 insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8340 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8341 insn_offset += 4;
8342 size -= 2;
8343
8344 while (size != 0)
8345 {
8346 insn = *stub++;
8347 --size;
8348 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8349 insn_offset += 4;
8350 }
8351
8352 /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8353 relocs to describe this relocation. */
8354 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8355 /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8356 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8357 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8358 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8359 memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8360 wrel++, rel++;
8361 wrel->r_offset += 4;
8362 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8363 }
8364 continue;
8365
8366 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8367 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8368 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8369 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8370 {
8371 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8372 break;
8373 }
8374 relocation
8375 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8376 h, relocation, rel);
8377 addend = 0;
8378 break;
8379
8380 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8381 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8382 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8383 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8384 {
8385 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8386 break;
8387 }
8388 relocation
8389 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8390 h, relocation, rel);
8391 addend = 0;
8392 break;
8393
8394 /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8395 section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8396 an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8397 AIX .toc section. */
8398 case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8399 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8400 {
8401 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8402 break;
8403 }
8404 BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
8405 ".got") == 0
8406 || strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
8407 ".cgot") == 0);
8408
8409 addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8410 break;
8411
8412 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8413 if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8414 {
8415 struct plt_entry *ent;
8416
8417 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8418 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8419 if (ent == NULL
8420 || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8421 {
8422 /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8423 happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8424 using -Bsymbolic. */
8425 }
8426 else
8427 {
8428 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8429 procedure linkage table. */
8430 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8431 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8432 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8433 + htab->glink->output_offset
8434 + ent->glink_offset);
8435 else
8436 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8437 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8438 + ent->plt.offset);
8439 }
8440 }
8441
8442 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8443 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8444 Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8445 addend = 0;
8446 break;
8447
8448 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8449 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8450 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8451 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8452 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8453 plt_list = NULL;
8454 if (h != NULL)
8455 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8456 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8457 plt_list = ifunc;
8458 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8459 {
8460 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8461 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8462 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8463 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8464 }
8465 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8466 if (plt_list != NULL)
8467 {
8468 struct plt_entry *ent;
8469
8470 ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8471 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8472 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8473 {
8474 asection *plt;
8475
8476 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8477 plt = htab->elf.splt;
8478 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8479 || h == NULL
8480 || h->dynindx == -1)
8481 {
8482 if (ifunc != NULL)
8483 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8484 else
8485 plt = htab->pltlocal;
8486 }
8487 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8488 + plt->output_offset
8489 + ent->plt.offset);
8490 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8491 {
8492 bfd_vma got = 0;
8493
8494 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8495 got = (ent->addend
8496 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8497 + ent->sec->output_offset);
8498 else
8499 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8500 relocation -= got;
8501 }
8502 }
8503 }
8504 addend = 0;
8505 break;
8506
8507 /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8508 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8509 {
8510 const char *name;
8511 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8512
8513 if (sec == NULL
8514 || sec->output_section == NULL
8515 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8516 {
8517 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8518 break;
8519 }
8520 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8521
8522 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8523 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8524 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8525 {
8526 _bfd_error_handler
8527 /* xgettext:c-format */
8528 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8529 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8530 input_bfd,
8531 sym_name,
8532 howto->name,
8533 name);
8534 }
8535 }
8536 break;
8537
8538 /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8539 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8540 {
8541 const char *name;
8542 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8543
8544 if (sec == NULL
8545 || sec->output_section == NULL
8546 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8547 {
8548 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8549 break;
8550 }
8551 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8552
8553 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8554 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8555 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8556 {
8557 _bfd_error_handler
8558 /* xgettext:c-format */
8559 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8560 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8561 input_bfd,
8562 sym_name,
8563 howto->name,
8564 name);
8565 }
8566 }
8567 break;
8568
8569 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8570 relocation = relocation + addend;
8571 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8572 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8573 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8574 goto copy_reloc;
8575
8576 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8577 relocation = relocation + addend;
8578 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8579 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8580 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8581 goto copy_reloc;
8582
8583 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8584 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8585 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8586 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8587 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8588 goto copy_reloc;
8589
8590 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8591 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8592 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8593 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8594 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8595 goto copy_reloc;
8596
8597 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8598 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8599 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8600 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8601 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8602 goto copy_reloc;
8603
8604 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8605 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8606 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8607 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8608 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8609 goto copy_reloc;
8610
8611 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8612 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8613 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8614 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8615 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8616 {
8617 const char *name;
8618 int reg;
8619 unsigned int insn;
8620 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8621
8622 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8623 {
8624 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8625 break;
8626 }
8627
8628 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8629 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8630 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8631 {
8632 reg = 13;
8633 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8634 }
8635 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8636 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8637 {
8638 reg = 2;
8639 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8640 }
8641 else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8642 || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8643 {
8644 reg = 0;
8645 }
8646 else
8647 {
8648 _bfd_error_handler
8649 /* xgettext:c-format */
8650 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8651 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8652 input_bfd,
8653 sym_name,
8654 howto->name,
8655 name);
8656
8657 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8658 ret = FALSE;
8659 goto copy_reloc;
8660 }
8661
8662 if (sda != NULL)
8663 {
8664 if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8665 {
8666 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8667 break;
8668 }
8669 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8670 }
8671
8672 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8673 break;
8674
8675 /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8676 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8677 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8678 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8679 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8680 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8681 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8682 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8683 rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8684
8685 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8686 if (reg == 0
8687 && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8688 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8689 {
8690 relocation = relocation + addend;
8691 addend = 0;
8692
8693 /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8694 insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8695 insn |= 28u << 26;
8696
8697 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8698 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8699 insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8700 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8701 insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8702 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8703 insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8704
8705 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8706
8707 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8708 && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8709 goto overflow;
8710 goto copy_reloc;
8711 }
8712 /* Fill in register field. */
8713 insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8714 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8715 }
8716 break;
8717
8718 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8719 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8720 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8721 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8722 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8723 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8724 {
8725 bfd_vma value;
8726 const char *name;
8727 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8728
8729 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8730 {
8731 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8732 break;
8733 }
8734
8735 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8736 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8737 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8738 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8739 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8740 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8741 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8742 else
8743 {
8744 _bfd_error_handler
8745 /* xgettext:c-format */
8746 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8747 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8748 input_bfd,
8749 sym_name,
8750 howto->name,
8751 name);
8752
8753 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8754 ret = FALSE;
8755 goto copy_reloc;
8756 }
8757
8758 if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8759 {
8760 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8761 break;
8762 }
8763 value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8764
8765 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8766 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8767 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8768 split16a_type,
8769 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8770 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8771 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8772 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8773 split16d_type,
8774 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8775 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8776 {
8777 value = value >> 16;
8778 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8779 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8780 split16a_type,
8781 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8782 }
8783 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8784 {
8785 value = value >> 16;
8786 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8787 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8788 split16d_type,
8789 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8790 }
8791 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8792 {
8793 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8794 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8795 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8796 split16a_type,
8797 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8798 }
8799 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8800 {
8801 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8802 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8803 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8804 split16d_type,
8805 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8806 }
8807 }
8808 goto copy_reloc;
8809
8810 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8811 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8812 continue;
8813
8814 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8815 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8816 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8817 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8818 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8819 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8820 {
8821 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8822 break;
8823 }
8824 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8825 break;
8826
8827 /* Negative relocations. */
8828 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8829 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8830 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8831 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8832 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8833 addend -= 2 * relocation;
8834 break;
8835
8836 case R_PPC_COPY:
8837 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8838 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8839 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8840 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8841 case R_PPC_PLT32:
8842 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8843 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8844 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8845 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8846 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8847 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8848 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8849 /* xgettext:c-format */
8850 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8851 input_bfd, howto->name);
8852
8853 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8854 ret = FALSE;
8855 goto copy_reloc;
8856 }
8857
8858 switch (r_type)
8859 {
8860 default:
8861 break;
8862
8863 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8864 if (unresolved_reloc)
8865 {
8866 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8867 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8868 insn &= 1;
8869 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8870 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8871 r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8872 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8873 }
8874 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8875 info->callbacks->einfo
8876 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8877 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8878 howto->name);
8879 break;
8880
8881 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8882 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8883 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8884 if (unresolved_reloc)
8885 {
8886 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8887 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8888 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8889 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8890 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8891 }
8892 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8893 info->callbacks->einfo
8894 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8895 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8896 howto->name);
8897 break;
8898 }
8899
8900 /* Do any further special processing. */
8901 switch (r_type)
8902 {
8903 default:
8904 break;
8905
8906 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8907 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8908 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8909 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8910 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8911 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8912 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8913 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8914 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8915 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8916 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8917 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8918 if (sec == NULL)
8919 break;
8920 /* Fall through. */
8921
8922 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8923 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8924 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8925 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8926 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8927 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8928 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8929 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8930 addend += 0x8000;
8931 break;
8932
8933 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8934 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8935 case R_PPC_GOT16:
8936 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8937 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8938 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8939 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8940 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8941 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8942 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8943 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8944 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8945 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8946 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8947 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8948 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8949 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8950 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8951 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8952 {
8953 /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8954 certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
8955 that make up part of the insn opcode. */
8956 unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8957
8958 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8959 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8960 mask = 0;
8961 if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8962 mask = 3;
8963 else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8964 mask = 15;
8965 else
8966 break;
8967 relocation += addend;
8968 addend = insn & mask;
8969 lobit = mask & relocation;
8970 if (lobit != 0)
8971 {
8972 relocation ^= lobit;
8973 info->callbacks->einfo
8974 /* xgettext:c-format */
8975 (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8976 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8977 howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8978 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8979 ret = FALSE;
8980 }
8981 }
8982 break;
8983 }
8984
8985 #ifdef DEBUG
8986 fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8987 "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8988 howto->name,
8989 (int) r_type,
8990 sym_name,
8991 r_symndx,
8992 (long) rel->r_offset,
8993 (long) addend);
8994 #endif
8995
8996 if (unresolved_reloc
8997 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8998 && h->def_dynamic)
8999 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
9000 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
9001 {
9002 info->callbacks->einfo
9003 /* xgettext:c-format */
9004 (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
9005 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9006 howto->name,
9007 sym_name);
9008 ret = FALSE;
9009 }
9010
9011 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
9012 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
9013 have different reloc types. */
9014 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
9015 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
9016 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
9017 {
9018 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
9019
9020 if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
9021 {
9022 unsigned int insn;
9023
9024 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
9025 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
9026 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
9027 else if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
9028 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
9029 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
9030 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
9031 }
9032 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9033 {
9034 alt_howto = *howto;
9035 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9036 howto = &alt_howto;
9037 }
9038 }
9039
9040 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9041 {
9042 /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9043 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
9044 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9045 else
9046 {
9047 unsigned int insn;
9048
9049 relocation += addend;
9050 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9051 + input_section->output_offset
9052 + input_section->output_section->vma);
9053 relocation >>= 16;
9054 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9055 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9056 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9057 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9058 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9059 }
9060 }
9061 else
9062 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9063 rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9064
9065 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9066 {
9067 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9068 {
9069 overflow:
9070 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9071 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9072 if (!warned
9073 && !(h != NULL
9074 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9075 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9076 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9077 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9078 (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9079 rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9080 }
9081 else
9082 {
9083 info->callbacks->einfo
9084 /* xgettext:c-format */
9085 (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9086 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9087 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9088 ret = FALSE;
9089 }
9090 }
9091 copy_reloc:
9092 if (wrel != rel)
9093 *wrel = *rel;
9094 }
9095
9096 if (wrel != rel)
9097 {
9098 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9099 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9100
9101 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9102 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9103 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9104 {
9105 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9106 one NONE reloc.
9107 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9108 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9109 deleted -= 1;
9110 wrel++;
9111 }
9112 relend = wrel;
9113 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9114 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9115 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9116 }
9117
9118 #ifdef DEBUG
9119 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9120 #endif
9121
9122 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9123 && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9124 && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9125 || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9126 {
9127 /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9128 unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9129 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9130 }
9131
9132 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9133 && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9134 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9135 || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9136 >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9137 {
9138 bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9139 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9140
9141 if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9142 {
9143 bfd_byte *p;
9144 unsigned int n;
9145 bfd_byte fill[4];
9146
9147 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9148 p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9149 n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9150 while (n--)
9151 {
9152 memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9153 p += 4;
9154 }
9155 }
9156
9157 /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9158 branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9159 branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9160 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9161 wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9162
9163 start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9164 + input_section->output_offset);
9165 end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9166 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9167 for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9168 addr < end_addr;
9169 addr += pagesize)
9170 {
9171 bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9172 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9173 bfd_boolean is_data;
9174 bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9175 unsigned int insn;
9176
9177 /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9178 the word alone. */
9179 is_data = FALSE;
9180 lo = relocs;
9181 hi = relend;
9182 rel = NULL;
9183 while (lo < hi)
9184 {
9185 rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9186 if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9187 lo = rel + 1;
9188 else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9189 hi = rel;
9190 else
9191 {
9192 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9193 {
9194 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9195 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9196 case R_PPC_REL32:
9197 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9198 is_data = TRUE;
9199 break;
9200 default:
9201 break;
9202 }
9203 break;
9204 }
9205 }
9206 if (is_data)
9207 continue;
9208
9209 /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9210 branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9211 avoid the icache failure.
9212
9213 The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9214 where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9215 page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9216 instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9217 unconditional branches:
9218 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9219 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9220 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9221 where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9222 prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9223 affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9224 instruction is not executed.
9225
9226 A bctr example:
9227 .
9228 . lis 9,new_page@ha
9229 . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9230 . mtctr 9
9231 . bctr
9232 . nop
9233 . nop
9234 . new_page:
9235 .
9236 The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9237 ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9238 new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9239 fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9240 bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9241 prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9242 place:
9243 .
9244 . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9245 . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9246 . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9247 . bctr bctr
9248 . nop b somewhere_else
9249 . b somewhere_else nop
9250 . new_page: new_page:
9251 . */
9252 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9253 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9254 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9255 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9256 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9257 && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9258 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9259 continue;
9260
9261 patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9262 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9263 patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9264 patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9265 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9266
9267 if (rel != NULL
9268 && rel->r_offset >= offset
9269 && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9270 {
9271 asection *sreloc;
9272
9273 /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9274 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9275 location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9276 if (rel + 1 != relend)
9277 {
9278 Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9279
9280 /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9281 memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9282 relend[-1] = tmp;
9283 }
9284 relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9285
9286 /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9287 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9288 {
9289 case R_PPC_REL16:
9290 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9291 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9292 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9293 relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9294 break;
9295 default:
9296 break;
9297 }
9298
9299 /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9300 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9301 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9302 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9303 if (sreloc != NULL)
9304 {
9305 Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9306 bfd_vma soffset;
9307
9308 slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9309 shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9310 soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9311 + input_section->output_offset);
9312 while (slo < shi)
9313 {
9314 Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9315 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9316 &outrel);
9317 if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9318 slo = srel + 1;
9319 else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9320 shi = srel;
9321 else
9322 {
9323 if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9324 {
9325 memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9326 (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9327 srel = srelend - 1;
9328 }
9329 outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9330 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9331 (bfd_byte *) srel);
9332 break;
9333 }
9334 }
9335 }
9336 }
9337 else
9338 rel = NULL;
9339
9340 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9341 && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9342 {
9343 bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9344
9345 delta += offset - patch_off;
9346 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9347 delta = 0;
9348 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9349 {
9350 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9351
9352 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9353 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9354 insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9355 else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9356 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9357 else
9358 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9359
9360 if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9361 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9362 && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9363 && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9364 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9365 }
9366 if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9367 {
9368 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9369 (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9370 contents + patch_off);
9371 patch_off += 4;
9372 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9373 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9374 contents + patch_off);
9375 patch_off += 4;
9376 }
9377 else
9378 {
9379 if (rel != NULL)
9380 {
9381 unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9382
9383 relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9384 relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9385 }
9386 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9387 (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9388 contents + patch_off);
9389 patch_off += 4;
9390 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9391 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9392 contents + patch_off);
9393 patch_off += 4;
9394 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9395 B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9396 contents + patch_off);
9397 patch_off += 4;
9398 }
9399 }
9400 else
9401 {
9402 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9403 patch_off += 4;
9404 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9405 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9406 contents + patch_off);
9407 patch_off += 4;
9408 }
9409 BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9410 relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9411 }
9412 }
9413
9414 return ret;
9415 }
9416 \f
9417 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9418
9419 static bfd_boolean
9420 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9421 {
9422 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9423 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9424 struct plt_entry *ent;
9425 bfd_boolean doneone;
9426
9427 doneone = FALSE;
9428 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9429 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9430 {
9431 if (!doneone)
9432 {
9433 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9434 bfd_byte *loc;
9435 bfd_vma reloc_index;
9436 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9437 asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9438
9439 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9440 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9441 || h->dynindx == -1)
9442 reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9443 else
9444 {
9445 reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9446 / htab->plt_slot_size);
9447 if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9448 && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9449 reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9450 }
9451
9452 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9453 Set it up. */
9454 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9455 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9456 && h->dynindx != -1)
9457 {
9458 bfd_vma got_offset;
9459 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9460
9461 /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9462 got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9463
9464 /* Use the right PLT. */
9465 plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9466 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9467
9468 /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9469 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9470 {
9471 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9472 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9473 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9474 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9475 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9476 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9477 }
9478 else
9479 {
9480 bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9481
9482 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9483 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9484 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9485 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9486 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9487 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9488 }
9489
9490 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9491 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9492 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9493 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9494
9495 /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9496 the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9497 start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9498 low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9499 /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9500 prescaled offset. */
9501 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9502 plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9503 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9504 /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9505 the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9506 instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9507 The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9508 stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9509 offset. */
9510 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9511 (plt_entry[5]
9512 | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9513 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9514 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9515 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9516 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9517 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9518
9519 /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9520 the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9521 in this PLT entry. */
9522 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9523 + plt->output_offset
9524 + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9525 htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9526
9527 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9528 {
9529 /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9530 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9531 + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9532 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9533 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9534
9535 /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9536 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9537 + plt->output_offset
9538 + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9539 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9540 R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9541 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9542 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9543 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9544
9545 /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9546 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9547 + plt->output_offset
9548 + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9549 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9550 R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9551 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9552 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9553 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9554
9555 /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9556 PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9557 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9558 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9559 + got_offset);
9560 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9561 R_PPC_ADDR32);
9562 rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9563 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9564 }
9565
9566 /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9567 In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9568 address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9569 by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9570 the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9571 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9572 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9573 + got_offset);
9574 rela.r_addend = 0;
9575 }
9576 else
9577 {
9578 rela.r_addend = 0;
9579 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9580 || h->dynindx == -1)
9581 {
9582 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9583 {
9584 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9585 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9586 }
9587 else
9588 {
9589 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9590 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9591 }
9592 if (h->def_regular
9593 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9594 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9595 rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9596 }
9597
9598 if (relplt == NULL)
9599 {
9600 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9601 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9602 }
9603 else
9604 {
9605 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9606 + plt->output_offset
9607 + ent->plt.offset);
9608
9609 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9610 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9611 || h->dynindx == -1)
9612 {
9613 /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9614 linker will fill it in. */
9615 }
9616 else
9617 {
9618 bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9619 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9620 + htab->glink->output_offset);
9621 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9622 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9623 }
9624 }
9625 }
9626
9627 if (relplt != NULL)
9628 {
9629 /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9630 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9631 || h->dynindx == -1)
9632 {
9633 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9634 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9635 else
9636 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9637 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9638 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9639 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9640 }
9641 else
9642 {
9643 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9644 loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9645 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9646 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9647 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9648 }
9649 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9650 }
9651 doneone = TRUE;
9652 }
9653
9654 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9655 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9656 || h->dynindx == -1)
9657 {
9658 unsigned char *p;
9659 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9660
9661 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9662 || h->dynindx == -1)
9663 {
9664 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9665 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9666 else
9667 break;
9668 }
9669
9670 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9671 write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9672
9673 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9674 /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9675 break;
9676 }
9677 else
9678 break;
9679 }
9680 return TRUE;
9681 }
9682
9683 /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9684
9685 bfd_boolean
9686 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9687 {
9688 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9689 bfd *ibfd;
9690
9691 if (!htab)
9692 return TRUE;
9693
9694 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9695
9696 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9697 {
9698 bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9699 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9700 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9701 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9702 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9703 struct plt_entry *ent;
9704
9705 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9706 continue;
9707
9708 local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9709 if (!local_got)
9710 continue;
9711
9712 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9713 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9714 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9715 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9716 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9717 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9718 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9719 {
9720 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9721 {
9722 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9723 asection *sym_sec;
9724 asection *plt, *relplt;
9725 bfd_byte *loc;
9726 bfd_vma val;
9727 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9728 unsigned char *p;
9729
9730 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9731 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9732 {
9733 if (local_syms != NULL
9734 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9735 free (local_syms);
9736 return FALSE;
9737 }
9738
9739 val = sym->st_value;
9740 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9741 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9742
9743 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9744 {
9745 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9746 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9747 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9748 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9749 }
9750 else
9751 {
9752 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9753 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9754 {
9755 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9756 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9757 }
9758 else
9759 {
9760 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9761 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9762 continue;
9763 }
9764 }
9765
9766 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9767 + plt->output_offset
9768 + plt->output_section->vma);
9769 rela.r_addend = val;
9770 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9771 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9772 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9773
9774 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9775 write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9776 }
9777 }
9778
9779 if (local_syms != NULL
9780 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9781 {
9782 if (!info->keep_memory)
9783 free (local_syms);
9784 else
9785 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9786 }
9787 }
9788 return TRUE;
9789 }
9790
9791 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9792 dynamic sections here. */
9793
9794 static bfd_boolean
9795 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9796 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9797 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9798 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9799 {
9800 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9801 struct plt_entry *ent;
9802
9803 #ifdef DEBUG
9804 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9805 h->root.root.string);
9806 #endif
9807
9808 if (!h->def_regular
9809 || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9810 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9811 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9812 {
9813 if (!h->def_regular)
9814 {
9815 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9816 defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9817 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9818 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9819 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9820 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9821 to zero. */
9822 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9823 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9824 sym->st_value = 0;
9825 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9826 {
9827 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9828 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9829 function pointer. */
9830 sym->st_value = 0;
9831 }
9832 }
9833 else
9834 {
9835 /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9836 executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9837 text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9838 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9839 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9840 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9841 relocation. */
9842 sym->st_shndx
9843 = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9844 (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9845 sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9846 + htab->glink->output_offset
9847 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9848 }
9849 break;
9850 }
9851
9852 if (h->needs_copy)
9853 {
9854 asection *s;
9855 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9856 bfd_byte *loc;
9857
9858 /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9859
9860 #ifdef DEBUG
9861 fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9862 #endif
9863
9864 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9865
9866 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9867 s = htab->relsbss;
9868 else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9869 s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9870 else
9871 s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9872 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9873
9874 rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9875 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9876 rela.r_addend = 0;
9877 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9878 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9879 }
9880
9881 #ifdef DEBUG
9882 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9883 #endif
9884
9885 return TRUE;
9886 }
9887 \f
9888 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9889 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9890 const asection *rel_sec,
9891 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9892 {
9893 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9894
9895 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9896 return reloc_class_ifunc;
9897
9898 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9899 {
9900 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9901 return reloc_class_relative;
9902 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9903 return reloc_class_plt;
9904 case R_PPC_COPY:
9905 return reloc_class_copy;
9906 default:
9907 return reloc_class_normal;
9908 }
9909 }
9910 \f
9911 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9912
9913 static bfd_boolean
9914 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9915 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9916 {
9917 asection *sdyn;
9918 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9919 bfd_vma got;
9920 bfd *dynobj;
9921 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9922
9923 #ifdef DEBUG
9924 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9925 #endif
9926
9927 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9928 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9929 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9930
9931 got = 0;
9932 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9933 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9934
9935 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9936 {
9937 Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9938
9939 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9940
9941 dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9942 dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9943 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9944 {
9945 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9946 asection *s;
9947
9948 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9949
9950 switch (dyn.d_tag)
9951 {
9952 case DT_PLTGOT:
9953 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9954 s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9955 else
9956 s = htab->elf.splt;
9957 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9958 break;
9959
9960 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9961 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9962 break;
9963
9964 case DT_JMPREL:
9965 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9966 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9967 break;
9968
9969 case DT_PPC_GOT:
9970 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9971 break;
9972
9973 case DT_TEXTREL:
9974 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9975 info->callbacks->einfo
9976 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9977 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9978 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9979 info->callbacks->einfo
9980 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9981 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9982 continue;
9983
9984 default:
9985 if (htab->is_vxworks
9986 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9987 break;
9988 continue;
9989 }
9990
9991 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9992 }
9993 }
9994
9995 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9996 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9997 {
9998 if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
9999 || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
10000 {
10001 unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
10002
10003 p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
10004 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
10005 {
10006 /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
10007 so that a function can easily find the address of
10008 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
10009 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
10010 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10011 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
10012 }
10013
10014 if (sdyn != NULL)
10015 {
10016 bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
10017 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
10018 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10019 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
10020 }
10021 }
10022 else
10023 {
10024 /* xgettext:c-format */
10025 _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
10026 htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
10027 (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
10028 ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
10029 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10030 ret = FALSE;
10031 }
10032
10033 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10034 }
10035
10036 /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10037 if (htab->is_vxworks
10038 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10039 && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10040 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10041 {
10042 asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10043 /* Use the right PLT. */
10044 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10045 ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10046 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10047
10048 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10049 {
10050 bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10051
10052 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10053 splt->contents + 0);
10054 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10055 splt->contents + 4);
10056 }
10057 else
10058 {
10059 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10060 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10061 }
10062 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10063 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10064 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10065 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10066 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10067 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10068
10069 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10070 {
10071 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10072 bfd_byte *loc;
10073
10074 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10075
10076 /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10077 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10078 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10079 + 2);
10080 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10081 rela.r_addend = 0;
10082 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10083 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10084
10085 /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10086 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10087 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10088 + 6);
10089 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10090 rela.r_addend = 0;
10091 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10092 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10093
10094 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10095 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10096 in which symbols were output. */
10097 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10098 {
10099 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10100
10101 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10102 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10103 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10104 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10105
10106 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10107 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10108 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10109 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10110
10111 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10112 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10113 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10114 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10115 }
10116 }
10117 }
10118
10119 if (htab->glink != NULL
10120 && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10121 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10122 {
10123 unsigned char *p;
10124 unsigned char *endp;
10125 bfd_vma res0;
10126
10127 /*
10128 * PIC glink code is the following:
10129 *
10130 * # ith PLT code stub.
10131 * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10132 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10133 * mtctr 11
10134 * bctr
10135 *
10136 * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10137 * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10138 * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10139 * res_0: b PLTresolve
10140 * res_1: b PLTresolve
10141 * .
10142 * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10143 * res_n_m3: nop
10144 * res_n_m2: nop
10145 * res_n_m1:
10146 *
10147 * PLTresolve:
10148 * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10149 * mflr 0
10150 * bcl 20,31,1f
10151 * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10152 * mflr 12
10153 * mtlr 0
10154 * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10155 * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10156 * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10157 * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10158 * mtctr 0
10159 * add 0,11,11
10160 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10161 * bctr
10162 *
10163 * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10164 *
10165 * # ith PLT code stub.
10166 * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10167 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10168 * mtctr 11
10169 * bctr
10170 *
10171 * The branch table is the same, then comes
10172 *
10173 * PLTresolve:
10174 * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10175 * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10176 * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10177 * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10178 * mtctr 0
10179 * add 0,11,11
10180 * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10181 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10182 * bctr
10183 */
10184
10185 /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10186 and perhaps some padding. */
10187 p = htab->glink->contents;
10188 p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10189 endp = htab->glink->contents;
10190 endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10191 while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10192 {
10193 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10194 p += 4;
10195 }
10196 while (p < endp)
10197 {
10198 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10199 p += 4;
10200 }
10201
10202 res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10203 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10204 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10205
10206 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10207 {
10208 /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10209 result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10210 glink branch table. */
10211 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10212 bfd_vma page_addr;
10213 bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10214 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10215
10216 for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10217 page_addr > glink_start;
10218 page_addr -= pagesize)
10219 {
10220 /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10221 bfd_byte *loc;
10222 unsigned int insn;
10223
10224 loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10225 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10226 if (insn == BCTR)
10227 {
10228 /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10229 one other call stub before this one. */
10230 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10231 if (insn == BCTR)
10232 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10233 else
10234 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10235 }
10236 }
10237 }
10238
10239 /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10240 endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10241 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10242 {
10243 bfd_vma bcl;
10244
10245 bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10246 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10247 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10248
10249 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10250 p += 4;
10251 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10252 p += 4;
10253 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10254 p += 4;
10255 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10256 p += 4;
10257 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10258 p += 4;
10259 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10260 p += 4;
10261 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10262 p += 4;
10263 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10264 p += 4;
10265 if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10266 {
10267 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10268 p += 4;
10269 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10270 p += 4;
10271 }
10272 else
10273 {
10274 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10275 p += 4;
10276 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10277 p += 4;
10278 }
10279 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10280 p += 4;
10281 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10282 }
10283 else
10284 {
10285 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10286 p += 4;
10287 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10288 p += 4;
10289 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10290 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10291 else
10292 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10293 p += 4;
10294 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10295 p += 4;
10296 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10297 p += 4;
10298 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10299 p += 4;
10300 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10301 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10302 else
10303 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10304 }
10305 p += 4;
10306 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10307 p += 4;
10308 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10309 p += 4;
10310 while (p < endp)
10311 {
10312 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10313 htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10314 p += 4;
10315 }
10316 BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10317 }
10318
10319 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10320 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10321 {
10322 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10323 bfd_vma val;
10324
10325 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10326 /* FDE length. */
10327 p += 4;
10328 /* CIE pointer. */
10329 p += 4;
10330 /* Offset to .glink. */
10331 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10332 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10333 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10334 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10335 val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10336 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10337
10338 if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10339 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10340 htab->glink_eh_frame,
10341 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10342 return FALSE;
10343 }
10344
10345 return ret;
10346 }
10347 \f
10348 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10349 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10350 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10351 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10352 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10353 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10354 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10355 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10356 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10357 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10358 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10359
10360 #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10361 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10362 #endif
10363
10364 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10365 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10366 #endif
10367
10368 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10369 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10370 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10371 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10372 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10373 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10374
10375 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10376 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10377 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10378 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10379 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10380 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10381 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10382 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10383
10384 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10385 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10386 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10387 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10388 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10389 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10390 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10391 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10392 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10393 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10394 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10395 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10396 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10397 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10398 #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10399 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10400 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10401 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10402 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10403 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10404 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10405 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10406 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10407 #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10408 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10409 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10410 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10411 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10412 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10413
10414 #include "elf32-target.h"
10415
10416 /* FreeBSD Target */
10417
10418 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10419 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10420
10421 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10422 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10423 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10424 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10425
10426 #undef ELF_OSABI
10427 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10428
10429 #undef elf32_bed
10430 #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10431
10432 #include "elf32-target.h"
10433
10434 /* VxWorks Target */
10435
10436 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10437 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10438
10439 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10440 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10441 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10442 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10443
10444 #undef ELF_OSABI
10445
10446 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10447 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10448 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10449 {
10450 if (sec->name == NULL)
10451 return NULL;
10452
10453 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10454 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10455
10456 return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10457 }
10458
10459 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10460 appropriately for VxWorks. */
10461 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10462 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10463 {
10464 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10465
10466 ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10467 if (ret)
10468 {
10469 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10470 = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10471 htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10472 htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10473 htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10474 htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10475 htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10476 }
10477 return ret;
10478 }
10479
10480 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10481 static bfd_boolean
10482 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10483 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10484 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10485 const char **namep,
10486 flagword *flagsp,
10487 asection **secp,
10488 bfd_vma *valp)
10489 {
10490 if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10491 valp))
10492 return FALSE;
10493
10494 return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10495 }
10496
10497 static bfd_boolean
10498 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10499 {
10500 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10501 return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10502 }
10503
10504 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10505 define it. */
10506 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10507 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10508 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10509 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10510 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10511 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10512 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10513 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10514 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10515 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10516 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10517 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10518 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10519 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10520
10521 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10522
10523 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10524 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10525 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10526 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10527 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10528 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10529 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10530 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10531 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10532 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10533 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10534 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10535 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10536 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10537 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10538 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10539 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10540 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10541
10542 #undef elf32_bed
10543 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10544 #undef elf_backend_post_process_headers
10545
10546 #include "elf32-target.h"